gdb_server: allow multiple GDB connections to selected targets
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
509 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
510 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
511 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
512 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
513
514 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
515 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
516 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
517
518 @section USB Other
519 @itemize @bullet
520 @item @b{USBprog}
521 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
522
523 @item @b{USB - Presto}
524 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
525
526 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
527 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
528
529 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
530 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
531
532 @item @b{Buspirate}
533 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
534
535 @item @b{opendous}
536 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
537
538 @item @b{estick}
539 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
540
541 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
543
544 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
546 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
547 @end itemize
548
549 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
550
551 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
552 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
553 these on the market.
554
555 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
556 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
557 of USB-based ones.
558
559 @itemize @bullet
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
562 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
563
564 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
565 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
566 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
567
568 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
569 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
570
571 @item @b{Wiggler2}
572 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
573
574 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
575 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
576
577 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
578 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
579
580 @item @b{arm-jtag}
581 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
582
583 @item @b{chameleon}
584 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
585
586 @item @b{Triton}
587 @* Unknown.
588
589 @item @b{Lattice}
590 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
591 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
592
593 @item @b{flashlink}
594 @* From STMicroelectronics;
595 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
596
597 @end itemize
598
599 @section Other...
600 @itemize @bullet
601
602 @item @b{ep93xx}
603 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
604
605 @item @b{at91rm9200}
606 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
607
608 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
609 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
610
611 @item @b{imx_gpio}
612 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
613
614 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
615 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
616 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
617
618 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
619 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
620 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
621 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
622 emulation model of target hardware.
623
624 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
625 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
626
627 @end itemize
628
629 @node About Jim-Tcl
630 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
631 @cindex Jim-Tcl
632 @cindex tcl
633
634 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
635 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
636 command interpreter.
637
638 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
639 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
640 much of anything about Tcl.
641 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
642
643 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
644 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
645 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
646 OpenOCD mailing list.
647
648 @itemize @bullet
649 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
650 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
651 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
652 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
653 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
654 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
655
656 @item @b{Missing Features}
657 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
658 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
659 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
660 enabled in OpenOCD.
661
662 @item @b{Scripts}
663 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
664 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
665 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
666
667 @item @b{Commands}
668 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
669 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
670 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
671 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
672
673 @item @b{Historical Note}
674 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
675 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
676 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
677 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
678
679 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
680 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
681 @end itemize
682
683 @node Running
684 @chapter Running
685 @cindex command line options
686 @cindex logfile
687 @cindex directory search
688
689 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
690 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
691 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
692 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
693 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
694 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
695 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
696
697 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
698 tell it how each debug session should work.
699 The @option{--help} option shows:
700 @verbatim
701 bash$ openocd --help
702
703 --help | -h display this help
704 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
705 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
706 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
707 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
708 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
709 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
710 --command | -c run <command>
711 @end verbatim
712
713 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
714 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
715 To specify one or more different
716 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
717
718 @example
719 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
720 @end example
721
722 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
723 @enumerate
724 @item the current directory,
725 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
726 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
727 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
728 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
729 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
730 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
731 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
732 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
733 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
734 @end enumerate
735 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
736
737 @quotation Note
738 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
739 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
740 @end quotation
741
742 @section Simple setup, no customization
743
744 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
745 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
746 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
747 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
748 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
749
750 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
751 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
752 the server with some variation of one of the following:
753
754 @example
755 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
756 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
757 @end example
758
759 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
760 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
761 If all goes well you'll see output something like
762
763 @example
764 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
765 For bug reports, read
766 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
767 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
768 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
769 @end example
770
771 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
772 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
773 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
774
775 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
776
777 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
778 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
779 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
780 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
781 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
782 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
783 ensure that this always succeeds.
784 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
785 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
786 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
787 and then shut down without acting as a server.
788
789 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
790 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
791 those channels.
792
793 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
794 the @option{-d} option.
795
796 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
797 @option{-c} command line switch.
798
799 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
800 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
801 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
802 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
803 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
804 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
805 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
806
807 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
808 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
809
810 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
811 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
812 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
813 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
814
815 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
816 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
817
818 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
819 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
820 and start the OpenOCD server.
821 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
822 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
823 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
824 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
825
826 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
827
828 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
829 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
830 and a USB cable on the other.
831 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
832 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
833
834 @enumerate
835 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
836 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
837 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
838 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
839 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
840 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
841 debugging host.
842
843 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
844 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
845 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
846 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
847 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
848
849 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
850 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
851 with 1.2 Volt boards.
852
853 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
854 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
855 ways to connect the cable.
856 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
857 Be sure it's firmly connected.
858
859 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
860 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
861 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
862 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
863 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
864 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
865 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
866 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
867
868 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
869 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
870 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
871 but are tedious to set up.
872 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
873 adapter signals to the right board pins.
874
875 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
876 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
877 you are using to run OpenOCD.
878 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
879
880 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
881 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
882 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
883 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
884
885 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
886 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
887 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
888
889 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
890 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
891 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
892 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
893
894 @end enumerate
895
896 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
897 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
898 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
899
900 @section Project Directory
901
902 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
903
904 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
905 single directory for your work with a given board.
906 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
907 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
908 files accessed through semihosting,
909 and for code you upload to the target board.
910 It is also the natural place to write files,
911 such as log files and data you download from the board.
912
913 @section Configuration Basics
914
915 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
916 a variety of ways you can mix them.
917 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
918
919 @itemize
920 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
921 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
922 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
923 @end itemize
924
925 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
926 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
927 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
928
929 @example
930 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
931
932 # GDB can also flash my flash!
933 gdb_memory_map enable
934 gdb_flash_program enable
935
936 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
937 @end example
938
939 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
940
941 @example
942 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
943 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
944 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
945 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
946 @end example
947
948 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
949 each supporting a different development task.
950 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
951 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
952
953 @quotation Important
954 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
955 problems with how it treats variables.
956 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
957 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
958 that can be tested in a later script.
959 @end quotation
960
961 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
962 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
963 to simplify your work.
964
965 @section User Config Files
966 @cindex config file, user
967 @cindex user config file
968 @cindex config file, overview
969
970 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
971 in one place.
972 One of the following will match your situation best:
973
974 @itemize
975 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
976 provided by someone else.
977 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
978 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
979 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
980 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
981 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
982 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
983
984 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
985 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
986
987 @enumerate
988 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
989 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
990 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
991 @end enumerate
992
993 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
994 The first is an interface config file.
995 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
996 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
997 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
998 meet your deadline:
999
1000 @example
1001 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1002 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1003 @end example
1004
1005 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1006 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1007 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1008 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1009
1010 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1011 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1012 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1013 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1014 target and board
1015 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1016 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1017
1018 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1019 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1020 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1021 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1022
1023 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1024 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1025 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1026 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1027 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1028
1029 @quotation Note
1030 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1031 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1032 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1033 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1034 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1035 @end quotation
1036
1037 @item
1038 You may need to write some C code.
1039 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1040 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1041 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1042 a new chip architecture.
1043 @end itemize
1044
1045 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1046 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1047 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1048
1049 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1050 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1051 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1052 @itemize
1053
1054 @item
1055 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1056 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1057 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1058 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1059
1060 @item
1061 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1062 @cindex vector_catch
1063 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1064 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1065 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1066 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1067 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1068 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1069
1070 @item
1071 You might need to override some defaults.
1072 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1073 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1074
1075 @item
1076 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1077 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1078 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1079 @end itemize
1080
1081 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1082
1083 A few project-specific utility
1084 routines may well speed up your work.
1085 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1086
1087 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1088 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1089 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1090 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1091 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1092 may help:
1093
1094 @example
1095 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1096 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1097 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1098 # Leave the CPU halted.
1099 reset init
1100
1101 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1102 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1103
1104 # Start running.
1105 resume 0x20000000
1106 @}
1107 @end example
1108
1109 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1110 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1111 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1112 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1113 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1114
1115 @example
1116 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1117 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1118 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1119 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1120 reset init
1121
1122 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1123 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1124 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1125 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1126 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1127 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1128 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1129
1130 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1131 reset run
1132 @}
1133 @end example
1134
1135 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1136 from NAND.
1137 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1138 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1139 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1140
1141 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1142 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1143
1144 @section Target Software Changes
1145
1146 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1147 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1148 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1149 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1150 handling issues like:
1151
1152 @itemize @bullet
1153
1154 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1155 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1156 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1157 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1158 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1159 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1160 your debug sessions.
1161
1162 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1163 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1164 That might however be your only option.
1165
1166 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1167 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1168 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1169 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1170 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1171 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1172 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1173 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1174 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1175 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1176 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1177 instead of the whole thing.
1178 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1179 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1180
1181 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1182 @cindex ARM semihosting
1183 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1184 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1185 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1186 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1187 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1188 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1189 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1190 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1191 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1192 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1193 NAND or SPI flash.
1194
1195 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1196 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1197 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1198 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1199 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1200
1201 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1202 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1203 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1204 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1205 registers which can be used to change various features including
1206 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1207 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1208 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1209 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1210 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1211
1212 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1213 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1214 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1215 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1216 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1217
1218 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1219 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1220 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1221 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1222 early code execution can be debugged
1223 or firmware can be replaced.
1224
1225 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1226 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1227 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1228 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1229 operations like writing to memory.)
1230
1231 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1232 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1233 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1234 various kinds of message.
1235 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1236
1237 @end itemize
1238
1239 @section Target Hardware Setup
1240
1241 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1242 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1243 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1244 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1245 working with.}
1246
1247 Common issues include:
1248
1249 @itemize @bullet
1250
1251 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1252 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1253 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1254 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1255 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1256 or one from a daughtercard).
1257 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1258 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1259
1260 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1261 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1262 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1263 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1264 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1265 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1266
1267 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1268 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1269 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1270 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1271 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1272
1273
1274 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1275 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1276 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1277 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1278 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1279 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1280 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1281
1282 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1283 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1284 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1285 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1286 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1287
1288 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1289 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1290 used to start booting.
1291
1292 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1293 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1294 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1295 multiple audio codec chips).
1296 This interacts with software
1297 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1298 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1299 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1300 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1301 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1302 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1303 audio or video codecs are used.
1304
1305 @end itemize
1306
1307 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1308 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1309 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1310 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1311 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1312 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1313 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1314 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1315 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1316 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1317
1318
1319 @node Config File Guidelines
1320 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1321
1322 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1323 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1324 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1325 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1326
1327 You should find the following directories under
1328 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1329 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1330 @itemize @bullet
1331 @item @file{interface} ...
1332 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1333 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1334 @item @file{board} ...
1335 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1336 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1337
1338 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1339 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1340 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1341 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1342 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1343 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1344 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1345 a CPU and an FPGA.
1346 @item @file{target} ...
1347 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1348 on a chip
1349 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1350 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1351 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1352 the target config file defines all of them.
1353 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1354 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1355 @end itemize
1356
1357 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1358 file may override features in any of the above files by
1359 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1360 commands specific to their situation.
1361
1362 @section Interface Config Files
1363
1364 The user config file
1365 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1366
1367 @example
1368 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1369 @end example
1370
1371 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1372 in use today with OpenOCD.
1373 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1374 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1375
1376 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1377 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1378 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1379 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1380 and need to provide a driver for it.
1381
1382 @section Board Config Files
1383 @cindex config file, board
1384 @cindex board config file
1385
1386 The user config file
1387 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1388
1389 @example
1390 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1391 @end example
1392
1393 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1394 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1395 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1396
1397 @enumerate
1398 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1399 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1400 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1401 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1402 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1403 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1404 @end enumerate
1405
1406 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1407 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1408 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1409 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1410
1411 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1412 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1413 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1414 configuration works.
1415
1416 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1417
1418 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1419 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1420 convention on how to use certain variables.
1421
1422 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1423 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1424 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1425 used at will within a target configuration file.
1426
1427 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1428 for a board with three chips:
1429
1430 @example
1431 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1432 set CHIPNAME network
1433 set ENDIAN big
1434 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1435 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1436 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1437 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1438
1439 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1440 set CHIPNAME video
1441 set ENDIAN little
1442 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1443 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1444 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1445 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1446
1447 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1448 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1449 unset ENDIAN
1450 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1451 @end example
1452
1453 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1454 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1455 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1456 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1457 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1458 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1459 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1460 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1461
1462 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1463 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1464 naming collisions.
1465
1466 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1467 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1468 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1469 up other clocks and peripherals.
1470
1471 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1472 @cindex variable names
1473
1474 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1475 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1476 one such chip (as shown above).
1477 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1478 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1479 to promote consistency and
1480 so that board files can override target defaults.
1481
1482 Inputs to target config files include:
1483
1484 @itemize @bullet
1485 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1486 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1487 tap identifier dotted names.
1488 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1489 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1490 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1491 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1492 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1493 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1494 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1495 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1496 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1497 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1498 @end itemize
1499
1500 Outputs from target config files include:
1501
1502 @itemize @bullet
1503 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1504 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1505 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1506 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1507 specific to that board and that target.
1508 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1509 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1510 @end itemize
1511
1512 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1513 @cindex event, reset-init
1514 @cindex reset-init handler
1515
1516 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1517 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1518 fully set up yet.
1519 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1520 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1521 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1522 handler is one of the most important.
1523
1524 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1525 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1526 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1527 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1528 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1529
1530 @quotation Note
1531 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1532 are included here.
1533 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1534 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1535 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1536 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1537 @end quotation
1538
1539 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1540 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1541 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1542 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1543 those as parameters.
1544 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1545 and disabling the watchdog.
1546 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1547 the next developer doing such work.
1548 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1549
1550 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1551 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1552 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1553 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1554
1555 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1556
1557 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1558 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1559 a low JTAG clock rate.
1560 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1561 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1562 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1563 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1564 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1565 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1566 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1567
1568 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1569 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1570 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1571 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1572 which might be less than that.
1573
1574 @quotation Warning
1575 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1576 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1577 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1578 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1579 @end quotation
1580
1581 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1582 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1583 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1584 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1585 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1586 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1587
1588 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1589 @subsection The init_board procedure
1590 @cindex init_board procedure
1591
1592 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1593 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1594 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1595 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1596 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1597 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1598 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1599 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1600 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1601 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1602 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1603 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1604
1605 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1606 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1607
1608 @example
1609 ### board_file.cfg ###
1610
1611 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1612 source [find target/target.cfg]
1613
1614 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1615 # enables fast on-board clock source
1616 # configures the chip to use it
1617 @}
1618
1619 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1620 proc init_board @{@} @{
1621 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1622
1623 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1624 adapter speed 100
1625 @}
1626
1627 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1628 enable_fast_clock
1629 adapter speed 10000
1630 @}
1631 @}
1632 @end example
1633
1634 @section Target Config Files
1635 @cindex config file, target
1636 @cindex target config file
1637
1638 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1639 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1640 more target config files like this:
1641
1642 @example
1643 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1644 @end example
1645
1646 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1647 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1648 In summary the target files should contain
1649
1650 @enumerate
1651 @item Set defaults
1652 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1653 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1654 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1655 @item On-Chip flash
1656 @end enumerate
1657
1658 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1659 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1660 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1661
1662 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1663 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1664 can talk to the chip.
1665 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1666 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1667 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1668 and other processing engines.
1669
1670 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1671
1672 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1673 letting board config files express environment-specific
1674 differences in how things should be set up.
1675
1676 @example
1677 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1678 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1679 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1680 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1681 @} else @{
1682 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1683 @}
1684
1685 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1686 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1687 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1688 @} else @{
1689 set _ENDIAN little
1690 @}
1691
1692 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1693 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1694 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1695 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1696 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1697 @} else @{
1698 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1699 @}
1700 @end example
1701 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1702
1703 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1704 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1705 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1706
1707 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1708 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1709 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1710
1711 @example
1712 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1713 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1714 @end example
1715
1716 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1717 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1718 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1719 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1720 for taps.
1721
1722 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1723 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1724 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1725 looks (in part) like this:
1726
1727 @example
1728 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1729 @end example
1730
1731 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1732 to source such a config file twice, with different
1733 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1734 it adds a different TAP each time.
1735
1736 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1737 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1738 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1739 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1740
1741 @example
1742 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1743 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1744 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1745 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1746 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1747 @end example
1748
1749 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1750 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1751
1752 @itemize
1753 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1754 plus a JRC to enable them
1755 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1756 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1757 is not currently used)
1758 @end itemize
1759
1760 @subsection Add CPU targets
1761
1762 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1763 GDB and other commands can use it.
1764 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1765 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1766 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1767 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1768
1769 @example
1770 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1771 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1772 @end example
1773
1774 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1775 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1776 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1777 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1778 a work area if you can.
1779 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1780
1781 @example
1782 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1783 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1784 @end example
1785
1786 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1787 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1788 @cindex SMP
1789 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1790
1791 @example
1792 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1793 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1794 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1795 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1796 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1797 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1798 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1799 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1800 @end example
1801 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1802 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1803 @itemize @bullet
1804 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1805 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1806 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1807 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1808 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1809 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1810 @end itemize
1811
1812 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1813 command have been implemented.
1814 @itemize @bullet
1815 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1816 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1817 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1818 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1819 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1820 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1821 following example.
1822 @end itemize
1823
1824 @example
1825 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1826 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1827 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1828 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1829 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1830 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1831 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1832 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1833 > resume
1834 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1835 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1836 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1837 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1838 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1839 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1840 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1841 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1842 @end example
1843
1844
1845 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1846
1847 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1848 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1849 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1850
1851 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1852 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1853 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1854 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1855 both signals.
1856
1857 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1858 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1859 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1860 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1861 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1862 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1863 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1864 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1865 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1866 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1867 not available.)
1868
1869 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1870 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1871 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1872 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1873 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1874 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1875 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1876 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1877
1878 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1879 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1880 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1881 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1882 slower clock than they will use later.
1883 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1884 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1885 than they will use later.
1886 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1887
1888 @quotation Important
1889 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1890 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1891 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1892 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1893 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1894 @end quotation
1895
1896 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1897 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1898 @cindex init_targets procedure
1899
1900 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1901 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1902 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1903 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1904 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1905 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1906 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1907 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1908 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1909
1910 @example
1911 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1912
1913 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1914 # basic initialization procedure ...
1915 @}
1916
1917 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1918 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1919 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1920 @}
1921
1922 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1923
1924 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1925
1926 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1927 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1928 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1929 @}
1930 @end example
1931
1932 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1933 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1934
1935 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1936
1937 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1938 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1939
1940 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1941 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1942 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1943
1944 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1945 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1946 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1947 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1948 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1949 events already assigned.
1950
1951 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1952
1953 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1954 special high speed download features - enable it.
1955
1956 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1957
1958 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1959 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1960 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1961 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1962 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1963 If you are using an external trace port,
1964 configure it in your board config file.
1965 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1966 configure it in your target config file.
1967
1968 @example
1969 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1970 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1971 @end example
1972
1973 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1974
1975 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1976
1977 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1978 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1979 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1980 the TARGET (chip) file.
1981
1982 Examples:
1983 @itemize @bullet
1984 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1985 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1986 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1987 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1988 @end itemize
1989
1990 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1991 @section Translating Configuration Files
1992 @cindex translation
1993 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1994 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1995 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1996 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1997 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1998 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1999
2000 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2001 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2002 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2003 convert other scripts later on.
2004
2005 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2006 replace job:
2007
2008 @example
2009 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2010 #
2011 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2012 #
2013 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2014 #
2015 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2016
2017 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2018 global TARGETNAME
2019
2020 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2021
2022 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2023 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2024 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2025 @}
2026 @end example
2027
2028
2029
2030 @node Server Configuration
2031 @chapter Server Configuration
2032 @cindex initialization
2033 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2034 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2035 supported.
2036
2037 @anchor{configurationstage}
2038 @section Configuration Stage
2039 @cindex configuration stage
2040 @cindex config command
2041
2042 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2043 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2044 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2045 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2046 inside startup scripts.
2047
2048 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2049 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2050 which may be issued interactively.
2051 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2052 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2053
2054 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2055 flash banks,
2056 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2057 and other basic setup.
2058 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2059 may access or activate TAPs.
2060 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2061 longer be issued.
2062
2063 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2064 @section Entering the Run Stage
2065
2066 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2067 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2068 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2069 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2070 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2071 You should see no errors at this point.
2072 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2073 commands you used to configure the server.
2074 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2075 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2076 on the scan chain.
2077
2078 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2079 become available.
2080 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2081 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2082 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2083 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2084 entry to the run stage.
2085
2086 @deffn {Config Command} init
2087 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2088 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2089 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2090 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2091 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2092 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2093
2094 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2095 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2096 configuration files and/or command line options.
2097
2098 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2099 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2100 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2101 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2102 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2103 @end deffn
2104
2105 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2106 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2107 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2108
2109 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2110 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2111 scan chain.
2112 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2113 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2114
2115 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2116 they return.
2117 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2118 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2119 @end deffn
2120
2121 @anchor{tcpipports}
2122 @section TCP/IP Ports
2123 @cindex TCP port
2124 @cindex server
2125 @cindex port
2126 @cindex security
2127 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2128 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2129 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2130
2131 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2132 access using one or more of these ports.
2133 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2134 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2135 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2136
2137 @anchor{gdb_port}
2138 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2139 @cindex GDB server
2140 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2141 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2142 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2143 the normal use cases.
2144
2145 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2146 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2147 disables the gdb server.
2148
2149 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2150 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2151
2152 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2153 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2154
2155 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2156 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2157 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2158
2159 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2160 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2161 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2162 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2163 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2164 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2165 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2166 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2167 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2168
2169 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2170 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2171 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2172 @end deffn
2173
2174 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2175 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2176 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2177 output from the Tcl engine.
2178 Intended as a machine interface.
2179 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2180 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2181 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2182 @end deffn
2183
2184 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2185 Specify or query the
2186 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2187 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2188 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2189 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2190 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2191 @end deffn
2192
2193 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2194 @section GDB Configuration
2195 @cindex GDB
2196 @cindex GDB configuration
2197 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2198 The ones listed here are static and global.
2199 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2200 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2201
2202 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2203 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2204 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2205 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2206 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2207 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2208 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2212 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2213 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2214 vFlash packet is received.
2215 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2220 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2221 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2222 for flash programming to work.
2223 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2224 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2225 @end deffn
2226
2227 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2228 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2229 by GDB memory read packets.
2230 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2231 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2232 @end deffn
2233
2234 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2235 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2236 packets report errors or not.
2237 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2238 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2239 @end deffn
2240
2241 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2242 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2243 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2244 @end deffn
2245
2246 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2247 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2248
2249 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2250 @end deffn
2251
2252 @anchor{eventpolling}
2253 @section Event Polling
2254
2255 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2256 where significant events can happen at any time.
2257 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2258 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2259 or to GDB.
2260
2261 Examples of such events include:
2262
2263 @itemize
2264 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2265 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2266 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2267 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2268 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2269 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2270 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2271 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2272 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2273 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2274 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2275 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2276 @end itemize
2277
2278 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2279 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2280 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2281 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2282 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2283
2284 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2285 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2286 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2287 to the various active targets.
2288 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2289 which is normally done in the background.
2290
2291 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2292 Poll the current target for its current state.
2293 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2294 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2295 specific information about the current state is printed.
2296 An optional parameter
2297 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2298
2299 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2300 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2301 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2302 @example
2303 > poll
2304 background polling: on
2305 target state: halted
2306 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2307 current mode: Supervisor
2308 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2309 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2310 >
2311 @end example
2312 @end deffn
2313
2314 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2315 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2316 @cindex config file, interface
2317 @cindex interface config file
2318
2319 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2320 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2321 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2322
2323 @quotation Note
2324 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2325 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2326 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2327 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2328 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2329 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2330 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2331 @end quotation
2332
2333 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2334 through commands in an interface configuration
2335 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2336 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2337
2338 @example
2339 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2340 @end example
2341
2342 These commands tell
2343 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2344 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2345
2346 @example
2347 # jlink interface
2348 adapter driver jlink
2349 @end example
2350
2351 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2352
2353
2354 @section Adapter Configuration
2355
2356 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2357 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2358 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2359
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2361 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2362 target.
2363 @end deffn
2364
2365 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2366 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2367 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2368 @end deffn
2369 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2370 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2371 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2372 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2373 the hardware can support.
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376
2377
2378 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2379 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2380 @end deffn
2381
2382 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2383 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2384 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2385 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2386 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2387 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2388 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2389
2390 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @section Interface Drivers
2394
2395 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2396 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2397 available at run time.
2398
2399 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2400 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2401 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2402 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2403
2404 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2405 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2406 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2410 Displays status of RTCK option.
2411 Optionally sets that option first.
2412 @end deffn
2413 @end deffn
2414
2415 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2416 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2417 This has one driver-specific command:
2418
2419 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2420 Logs some status
2421 @end deffn
2422 @end deffn
2423
2424 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2425 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2426 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2427 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2428 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2429 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2430 @end deffn
2431
2432 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2433 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2434
2435 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2436 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2437 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2438 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2439 @example
2440 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2441 @end example
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2445 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2446 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2447 @end deffn
2448
2449 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2450 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2451 @end deffn
2452 @end deffn
2453
2454 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2455 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2456 @end deffn
2457
2458 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2459 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2460 @end deffn
2461
2462 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2463 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2464 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2465
2466 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2467 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2468
2469 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2470 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2471
2472 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2473 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2474 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2475 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2476 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2477 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2478
2479 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2480 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2481 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2482 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2483 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2484
2485 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2486 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2487 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2488 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2489
2490 @itemize @minus
2491 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2492 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2493 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2494 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2495 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2496 switching data and direction as necessary
2497 @end itemize
2498
2499 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2500 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2501
2502 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2503 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2504 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2505 @example
2506 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2507 @end example
2508 @end deffn
2509
2510 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2511 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2512 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2513 during device selection.
2514 @end deffn
2515
2516 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2517 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2518 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2519 is connected to the host.
2520 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2521 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2522 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2523 @end deffn
2524
2525 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2526 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2527 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2528
2529 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2530 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2531 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2532 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2533 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2534
2535 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2536 @end deffn
2537
2538 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2539 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2540 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2541 @end deffn
2542
2543 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2544 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2545 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2546 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2547 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2548 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2549 and initially asserted reset signals.
2550 @end deffn
2551
2552 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2553 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2554 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2555 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2556 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2557 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2558 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2559 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2560 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2561 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2562 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2563
2564 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2565 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2566 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2567 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2568 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2569 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2570
2571 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2572 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2573 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2574 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2575 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2576 are always driven by the FTDI.
2577
2578 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2579 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2580 @var{name}.
2581 @end deffn
2582
2583 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2584 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2585 @itemize @minus
2586 @item @option{0}, drive low
2587 @item @option{1}, drive high
2588 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2589 @end itemize
2590 @end deffn
2591
2592 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2593 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2597 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2598
2599 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2600 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2601 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2602 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2603 @itemize @minus
2604 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2605 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2606 @end itemize
2607 @end deffn
2608
2609 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2610 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2611
2612 @end deffn
2613
2614 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2615 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2616 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2617 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2618
2619 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2620 @itemize @minus
2621 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2622 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2623 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2624 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2625 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2626 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2627 @end itemize
2628
2629 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2630 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2631 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2632 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2633 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2634 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2635 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2636 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2637
2638 FT232R
2639 @itemize @minus
2640 @item bit 7 - RI
2641 @item bit 6 - DCD
2642 @item bit 5 - DSR
2643 @item bit 4 - DTR
2644 @item bit 3 - CTS
2645 @item bit 2 - RTS
2646 @item bit 1 - RXD
2647 @item bit 0 - TXD
2648 @end itemize
2649
2650 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2651 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2652
2653 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2654 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2655 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2656 @end deffn
2657
2658 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2659 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2660 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2661 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2662 @end deffn
2663
2664 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2665 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2666 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2667 @end deffn
2668
2669 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2670 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2671 @end deffn
2672
2673 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2674 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2675 @end deffn
2676
2677 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2678 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2679 @end deffn
2680
2681 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2682 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2683 @end deffn
2684
2685 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2686 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2687 @end deffn
2688
2689 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2690 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2691 @end deffn
2692
2693 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2694 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2695 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2696 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2697 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2698 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2699 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2700 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2701 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2702 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @end deffn
2706
2707 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2708 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2709 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2710 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2711
2712 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2713 processors which are being simulated.
2714
2715 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2716 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2717 sockets instead of TCP.
2718 @end deffn
2719
2720 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2721 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2722 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2723 @end deffn
2724
2725 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2726 something like:
2727
2728 @example
2729 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2730 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2731 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2732 @end example
2733
2734 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2735 named mysocket:
2736
2737 @example
2738 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2739 remote_bitbang_port 0
2740 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2741 @end example
2742 @end deffn
2743
2744 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2745 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2746 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2747 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2748
2749 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2750 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2751 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2752 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2753 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2754 @end deffn
2755
2756 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2757 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2758 default values are used.
2759 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2760 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2761 @example
2762 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2763 @end example
2764 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2765 @example
2766 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2767 @end example
2768 @end deffn
2769
2770 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2771 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2772 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2773 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2774 target board.
2775
2776 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2777 @example
2778 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2779 reset_config srst_only
2780 @end example
2781 @end deffn
2782
2783 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2784 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2785 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2786 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2787 @end deffn
2788
2789 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2790 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2791 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2792 @end deffn
2793
2794 @end deffn
2795
2796 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2797 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2798 This has one driver-specific command:
2799
2800 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2801 Display either the address of the I/O port
2802 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2803 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2804 This is a write-once setting.
2805 @end deffn
2806 @end deffn
2807
2808 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2809 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2810 transports.
2811
2812 @quotation Compatibility Note
2813 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2814 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2815 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2816 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2817 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2818 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2819 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2820 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2821 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2822 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2823 @end quotation
2824
2825 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2826 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2827 states.
2828 @end deffn
2829 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2830 Display free device internal memory.
2831 @end deffn
2832 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2833 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2834 command version.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2837 Display the device configuration.
2838 @end deffn
2839 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2840 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2841 power state.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2844 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2847 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2848 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2849 IP configuration.
2850 @end deffn
2851 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2852 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2853 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2854 @end deffn
2855 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2856 Reset the current configuration.
2857 @end deffn
2858 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2859 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2862 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2863 pairs.
2864
2865 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2866 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2867 @example
2868 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2869 @end example
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2872 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2873 pairs.
2874
2875 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2876 @example
2877 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2878 77a90000
2879 @end example
2880 @end deffn
2881 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2882 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2883 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2884 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2885 instead.
2886
2887 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2888 @end deffn
2889 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2890 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2891 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2892
2893 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2894 @end deffn
2895 @end deffn
2896
2897 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2898 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2899 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2900 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2901 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2902 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2903 configuration script.
2904
2905 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2906 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2907 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2908 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2909 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2910
2911 Known limitations:
2912 @itemize @bullet
2913 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2914 and 2.7 MHz.
2915 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2916 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2917 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2918 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2919 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2920 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2921 communications with the target.
2922 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2923 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2924 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2925 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2926 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2927 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2928 @end itemize
2929
2930 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2931 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2932 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2933 @end deffn
2934
2935 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2936 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2937 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2938 @end deffn
2939
2940 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2941 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2942 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2943 target as a side-effect.
2944 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2945 @end deffn
2946
2947 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2948 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2949 version, and target voltage.
2950 @end deffn
2951 @end deffn
2952
2953 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2954 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2955 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2956 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2957 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2958
2959 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2960 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2961 This is a write-once setting.
2962 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2963
2964 @itemize @minus
2965 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2966 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2967 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2968 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2969 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2970 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2971 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2972 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2973 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2974 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2975 some versions of
2976 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2977 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2978 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2979 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2980 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2981 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2982 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2983 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2984 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2985 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2986 @end itemize
2987 @end deffn
2988
2989 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2990 Display either the address of the I/O port
2991 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2992 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2993 This is a write-once setting.
2994
2995 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2996 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2997 you may encounter a problem.
2998 @end deffn
2999
3000 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3001 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3002 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3003 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3004 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3005 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3006
3007 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3008 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3009 @quotation Tip
3010 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3011 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3012 @example
3013 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3014 > adapter speed 500
3015 @end example
3016 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3017 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3018 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3019 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3020 large set of samples.
3021 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3022 @example
3023 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3024 @end example
3025 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3026 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3027
3028 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3029 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3030 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3031 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3032 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3033 be conservative.
3034 @end quotation
3035 @end deffn
3036
3037 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3038 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3039 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3040 @end deffn
3041
3042 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3043 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3044
3045 @example
3046 adapter driver parport
3047 parport_port 0x278
3048 parport_cable wiggler
3049 @end example
3050 @end deffn
3051
3052 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3053 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3054 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3055 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3056 @end deffn
3057 @end deffn
3058
3059 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3060 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3064 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3065 @end deffn
3066
3067 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3068 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3069
3070 @quotation Note
3071 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3072 which are not currently documented here.
3073 @end quotation
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @anchor{hla_interface}
3077 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3078 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3079 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3080 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3081
3082 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3083 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3084 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3085 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3086 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3087 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3088
3089 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3090 Currently Not Supported.
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3094 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3098 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3099 @end deffn
3100
3101 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3102 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3103 @end deffn
3104
3105 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3106 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3107 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3108 @end deffn
3109 @end deffn
3110
3111 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3112 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3113 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3114 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3115 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3116
3117 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3118 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3119 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3120 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3121
3122 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3123 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3124
3125 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3126 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3130 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3131 @end deffn
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3135 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3136 @end deffn
3137
3138 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3139 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3140 @end deffn
3141
3142 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3143 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3144 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3145 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3146 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3147
3148 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3149 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3150 XDS110 found will be used.
3151 @end deffn
3152
3153 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3154 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3155 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3156 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3160 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3161 version).
3162 @end deffn
3163 @end deffn
3164
3165 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3166 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3167 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3168 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3169 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3170
3171 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3172
3173 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3174 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3175
3176 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3177 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3178
3179 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3180
3181 @end deffn
3182 @end deffn
3183
3184 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3185 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3186 @end deffn
3187
3188 @quotation Note
3189 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3190 which are not currently documented here.
3191 @end quotation
3192
3193 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3194 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3195 No arguments: print status.
3196 @end deffn
3197
3198 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3199 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3200 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3201
3202 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3203 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3204 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3205 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3206 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3207 configuration on exit.
3208
3209 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3210 pinout.
3211
3212 @end deffn
3213
3214 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3215 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3216 of the one which is most popular.
3217
3218 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3219
3220 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3221 pinout.
3222
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225
3226 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3227 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3228 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3229
3230 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3231 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3232 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3233
3234 @itemize @minus
3235 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3236 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3237 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3238 @end itemize
3239 @end deffn
3240
3241 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3242 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3243 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3244 @end deffn
3245 @end deffn
3246
3247
3248 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3249 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3250 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3251 DPI server interface.
3252
3253 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3254 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3255 @end deffn
3256
3257 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3258 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3259 @end deffn
3260 @end deffn
3261
3262
3263 @section Transport Configuration
3264 @cindex Transport
3265 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3266 and the debug adapter you are using,
3267 several transports may be available to
3268 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3269 @deffn Command {transport list}
3270 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3271 version of OpenOCD.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3275 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3276
3277 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3278 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3279 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3280 adapter's driver).
3281
3282 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3283 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3284 supported by the debug adapter.
3285
3286 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3287 transport, if any.
3288 @end deffn
3289
3290 @subsection JTAG Transport
3291 @cindex JTAG
3292 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3293 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3294 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3295 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3296 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3297 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3298
3299 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3300 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3301 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3302 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3303 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3304
3305 @subsection SWD Transport
3306 @cindex SWD
3307 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3308 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3309 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3310 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3311 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3312 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3313 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3314
3315 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3316 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3317 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3318 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3319 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3320
3321 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3322 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3323 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3324 expected to change.
3325 @end deffn
3326 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3327 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3328 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3329 No parameters: displays current settings.
3330 @end deffn
3331
3332 @subsection SPI Transport
3333 @cindex SPI
3334 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3335 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3336 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3337 solution for flash programming.
3338
3339 @anchor{swimtransport}
3340 @subsection SWIM Transport
3341 @cindex SWIM
3342 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3343 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3344 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3345 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3346
3347 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3348
3349 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3350
3351 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3352 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3353 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3354 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3355 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3356
3357 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3358 @section JTAG Speed
3359 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3360 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3361 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3362 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3363 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3364 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3365 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3366 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3367 power management software that may be active.
3368
3369 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3370 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3371 target event handler.
3372 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3373 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3374 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3375 sets up those clocks).
3376 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3377 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3378 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3379 in the target config file.
3380 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3381 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3382 config file instead.
3383 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3384 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3385 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3386
3387 @example
3388 jtag_rclk 3000
3389 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3390 @end example
3391
3392 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3393 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3394 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3395 may not be the fastest solution.
3396
3397 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3398 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3399 which support adaptive clocking.
3400
3401 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3402 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3403 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3404 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3405 than the speed specified.
3406
3407 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3408 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3409 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3410 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3411
3412 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3413 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3414 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3415 JTAG clocking after setup.
3416 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3417 If the interface device can not
3418 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3419 @end deffn
3420
3421 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3422 @cindex adaptive clocking
3423 @cindex RTCK
3424 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3425 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3426 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3427 @example
3428 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3429 jtag_rclk 3000
3430 @end example
3431 @end defun
3432
3433 @node Reset Configuration
3434 @chapter Reset Configuration
3435 @cindex Reset Configuration
3436
3437 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3438 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3439 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3440 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3441 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3442 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3443 Please see the various board files for examples.
3444
3445 @quotation Note
3446 To maintainers and integrators:
3447 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3448 Normally the board configuration file
3449 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3450 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3451
3452 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3453 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3454 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3455 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3456 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3457 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3458 @end quotation
3459
3460 @section Types of Reset
3461
3462 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3463 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3464 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3465
3466 @itemize @bullet
3467 @item
3468 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3469 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3470 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3471 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3472 @item
3473 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3474 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3475 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3476 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3477 @item
3478 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3479 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3480 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3481 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3482 @item
3483 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3484 several other types of reset.
3485 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3486 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3487 There may be individual module resets.
3488 @end itemize
3489
3490 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3491 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3492 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3493 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3494 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3495 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3496 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3497 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3498 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3499
3500 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3501 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3502
3503 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3504 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3505 common issues are:
3506
3507 @itemize @bullet
3508
3509 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3510 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3511 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3512 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3513 when either of those signals is not connected.
3514 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3515 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3516 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3517 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3518
3519 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3520 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3521 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3522 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3523
3524 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3525 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3526 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3527 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3528 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3529 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3530 hardware debouncing.
3531 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3532 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3533
3534 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3535 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3536 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3537 to use push/pull output drivers.
3538 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3539 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3540 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3541 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3542
3543 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3544 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3545 issues (not limited to errata).
3546 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3547 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3548 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3549 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3550 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3551 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3552 @end itemize
3553
3554 There can also be other issues.
3555 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3556 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3557 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3558 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3559 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3560 Agreement (NDA).
3561
3562 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3563 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3564 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3565
3566 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3567 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3568
3569 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3570
3571 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3572 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3573 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3574 allowing it to be deasserted.
3575 @end deffn
3576
3577 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3578 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3579 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3580 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3581 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3582 @end deffn
3583
3584 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3585 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3586 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3587 allowing it to be deasserted.
3588 @end deffn
3589
3590 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3591 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3592 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3593 @end deffn
3594
3595 @anchor{reset_config}
3596 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3597 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3598 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3599 configuration scripts.
3600
3601 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3602 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3603 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3604 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3605 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3606 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3607 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3608 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3609
3610 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3611 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3612 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3613 -- may be specified at a time.
3614 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3615 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3616 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3617 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3618 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3619
3620 @itemize
3621 @item
3622 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3623 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3624 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3625 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3626 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3627
3628 @quotation Tip
3629 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3630 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3631 @end quotation
3632
3633 @item
3634 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3635 signal implementations.
3636 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3637 indicating everything behaves normally.
3638 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3639 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3640 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3641 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3642 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3643 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3644 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3645
3646 @item
3647 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3648 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3649 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3650 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3651 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3652 while SRST is asserted.
3653 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3654 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3655
3656 @item
3657 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3658 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3659 is required to use this option.
3660 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3661 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3662 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3663 be asserted before any target connection.
3664 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3665 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3666 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3667 @end itemize
3668
3669 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3670 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3671 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3672 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3673 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3674
3675 @itemize
3676 @item
3677 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3678 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3679 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3680 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3681
3682 @item
3683 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3684 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3685 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3686 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3687 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3688 @end itemize
3689 @end deffn
3690
3691 @section Custom Reset Handling
3692 @cindex events
3693
3694 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3695 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3696 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3697 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3698 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3699 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3700
3701 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3702 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3703 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3704 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3705 want to reset everything at once.
3706
3707 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3708 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3709 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3710 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3711 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3712 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3713 needs special attention.
3714
3715 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3716 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3717 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3718 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3719 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3720 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3721 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3722 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3723 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3724
3725 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3726 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3727 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3728 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3729 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3730
3731 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3732 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3733 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3734 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3735 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3736 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3737 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3738 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3739 or potentially some other value.
3740
3741 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3742 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3743 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3744 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3745 (or their associated targets)
3746 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3747
3748 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3749 they return.
3750 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3751 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3752 @end deffn
3753
3754 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3755 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3756 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3757 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3758 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3759 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3760 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3761 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3762 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3763 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3764 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3765 @end deffn
3766
3767 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3768 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3769 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3770 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3771 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3772 @end deffn
3773
3774
3775 @node TAP Declaration
3776 @chapter TAP Declaration
3777 @cindex TAP declaration
3778 @cindex TAP configuration
3779
3780 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3781 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3782
3783 @itemize @bullet
3784 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3785 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3786 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3787 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3788 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3789 start running that code.
3790 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3791 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3792 and missing connections.
3793 @end itemize
3794
3795 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3796 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3797 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3798 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3799 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3800
3801 @section Scan Chains
3802 @cindex scan chain
3803
3804 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3805 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3806 They also need to be added to
3807 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3808 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3809 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3810 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3811 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3812 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3813 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3814 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3815
3816 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3817 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3818 command, presented in the next chapter.
3819 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3820 debugging targets.)
3821 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3822
3823 @verbatim
3824 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3825 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3826 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3827 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3828 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3829 @end verbatim
3830
3831 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3832 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3833 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3834 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3835 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3836 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3837 until they are told to do so.
3838
3839 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3840 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3841 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3842 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3843
3844 @example
3845 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3846 @end example
3847
3848 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3849 by a given chip.
3850 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3851 and so forth.
3852 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3853 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3854 both inside a single chip and between them.
3855 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3856
3857 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3858 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3859 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3860 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3861 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3862 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3863 includes commands something like this:
3864
3865 @example
3866 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3867 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3868 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3869 @end example
3870
3871 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3872 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3873 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3874
3875 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3876 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3877 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3878 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3879 @example
3880 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3881 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3882 @}
3883 @end example
3884 @end deffn
3885
3886 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3887 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3888 and their status.
3889 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3890 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3891 but systems with a JTAG router can
3892 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3893 @end deffn
3894
3895 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3896 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3897
3898 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3899 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3900
3901 @section TAP Names
3902 @cindex dotted name
3903
3904 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3905 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3906 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3907 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3908 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3909 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3910 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3911 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3912
3913 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3914 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3915 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3916
3917 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3918
3919 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3920 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3921 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3922 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3923
3924 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3925 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3926 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3927 overridable.
3928
3929 @cindex TAP naming convention
3930 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3931 and should follow this convention:
3932
3933 @itemize @bullet
3934 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3935 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3936 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3937 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3938 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3939 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3940 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3941 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3942 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3943 with a single TAP;
3944 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3945 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3946 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3947 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3948 @end itemize
3949
3950 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3951
3952 @itemize @bullet
3953 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3954 @*The length in bits of the
3955 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3956 @end itemize
3957
3958 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3959
3960 @itemize @bullet
3961 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3962 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3963 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3964 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3965 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3966 (the TAP is linked in).
3967 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3968 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3969 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3970 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3971 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3972 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3973 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3974 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3975 values that were found but not included in the list.
3976
3977 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3978 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3979 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3980 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3981 hardware to find these values.
3982 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3983 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3984 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3985 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3986 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3987 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3988 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3989 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3990 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3991 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3992 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3993 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3994 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3995 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3996 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3997 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3998 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3999 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4000 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4001 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4002 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4003 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4004 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4005 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4006 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4007 @end itemize
4008 @end deffn
4009
4010 @section Other TAP commands
4011
4012 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4013 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4014 @end deffn
4015
4016 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4017 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4018 At this writing this TAP attribute
4019 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4020 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4021 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4022 See the next section for information about the available events.
4023
4024 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4025 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4026 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4027 @end deffn
4028
4029 @section TAP Events
4030 @cindex events
4031 @cindex TAP events
4032
4033 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4034 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4035 The other applies to debugger targets,
4036 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4037
4038 The TAP events currently defined are:
4039
4040 @itemize @bullet
4041 @item @b{post-reset}
4042 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4043 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4044 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4045 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4046 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4047
4048 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4049 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4050 of any particular target.
4051 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4052 @item @b{setup}
4053 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4054 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4055 @item @b{tap-disable}
4056 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4057 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4058 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4059 @item @b{tap-enable}
4060 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4061 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4062 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4063 @end itemize
4064
4065 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4066 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4067 contents to be accurate), you might:
4068
4069 @example
4070 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4071 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4072 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4073 @}
4074 @end example
4075
4076
4077 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4078 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4079 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4080 @cindex jrc
4081
4082 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4083 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4084 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4085 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4086 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4087
4088 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4089 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4090 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4091 be visible.
4092 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4093 ignores, such as:
4094
4095 @itemize
4096 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4097 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4098 TAPs receive new instructions.
4099 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4100 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4101 @end itemize
4102
4103 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4104 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4105 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4106 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4107
4108 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4109 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4110
4111 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4112 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4113 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4114 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4115 should define TAP event handlers using
4116 code that looks something like this:
4117
4118 @example
4119 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4120 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4121 @}
4122 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4123 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4124 @}
4125 @end example
4126
4127 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4128
4129 @example
4130 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4131 @end example
4132
4133 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4134 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4135 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4136 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4137
4138 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4139 If necessary, disables the tap
4140 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4141 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4142 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4143 and "0" if it is disabled.
4144 @end deffn
4145
4146 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4147 If necessary, enables the tap
4148 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4149 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4150 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4151 and "0" if it is disabled.
4152 @end deffn
4153
4154 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4155 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4156 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4157 and "0" if it is disabled.
4158
4159 @quotation Note
4160 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4161 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4162 @end quotation
4163 @end deffn
4164
4165 @anchor{autoprobing}
4166 @section Autoprobing
4167 @cindex autoprobe
4168 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4169
4170 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4171 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4172 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4173 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4174
4175 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4176 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4177 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4178 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4179 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4180 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4181 right when they come out of reset).
4182
4183 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4184
4185 @example
4186 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4187 reset_config trst_and_srst
4188 jtag_rclk 8
4189 @end example
4190
4191 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4192 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4193
4194 @enumerate
4195 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4196 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4197 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4198 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4199 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4200 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4201 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4202 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4203 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4204 that is discovered.
4205 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4206 register, it will report it.
4207 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4208 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4209 @end enumerate
4210
4211 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4212 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4213 that's a bit more complex:
4214
4215 @example
4216 clock speed 8 kHz
4217 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4218 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4219 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4220 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4221 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4222 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4223 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4224 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4225 @end example
4226
4227 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4228 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4229 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4230 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4231 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4232 and so forth.
4233
4234 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4235 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4236 @cindex DAP declaration
4237
4238 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4239 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4240 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4241 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4242 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4243
4244 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4245
4246 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4247 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4248 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4249 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4250 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4251
4252 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4253
4254 @itemize @bullet
4255 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4256 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4257 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4258 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4259 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4260 @end itemize
4261 @end deffn
4262
4263 @deffn Command {dap names}
4264 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4265 for TCL scripting.
4266 @end deffn
4267
4268 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4269 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4270 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4271 @end deffn
4272
4273 @deffn Command {dap init}
4274 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4275 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4276 initialization, too.
4277 @end deffn
4278
4279 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4280
4281 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4282 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4283 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4284 @end deffn
4285
4286 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4287 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4288 @end deffn
4289
4290 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4291 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4292 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4293 or set a new value @var{value}.
4294 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4295 @end deffn
4296
4297 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4298 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4299 @end deffn
4300
4301 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4302 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4303 value @var{value}.
4304
4305 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4306 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4307 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4308
4309 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4310 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4311 @end deffn
4312
4313 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4314 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4315 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4316 @end deffn
4317
4318 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4319 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4320 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4321 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4322 @end deffn
4323
4324 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4325 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4326
4327 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4328 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4329 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4330 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4331 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4332 for details.
4333
4334 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4335 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4336 the pattern:
4337 @example
4338 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4339 @end example
4340
4341 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4342 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4343 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4344 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4345 @example
4346 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4347 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4348 @end example
4349
4350 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4351 @example
4352 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4353 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4354 @end example
4355
4356 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4357 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4358
4359 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4360 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4361 example with a proper dap name:
4362 @example
4363 xxx.dap apcsw default
4364 @end example
4365 @end deffn
4366
4367 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4368 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4369 Disabled by default
4370 @end deffn
4371
4372
4373 @node CPU Configuration
4374 @chapter CPU Configuration
4375 @cindex GDB target
4376
4377 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4378 You can also access these targets without GDB
4379 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4380 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4381 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4382 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4383
4384 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4385 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4386
4387 @section Target List
4388 @cindex target, current
4389 @cindex target, list
4390
4391 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4392 where each member has a name.
4393 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4394 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4395 (plural!) command.
4396 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4397 look like with more than one:
4398 @verbatim
4399 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4400 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4401 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4402 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4403 @end verbatim
4404
4405 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4406 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4407 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4408 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4409 space seen by that current target.
4410 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4411 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4412 are examples; and there are many more.
4413
4414 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4415
4416 @deffn Command {target current}
4417 Returns the name of the current target.
4418 @end deffn
4419
4420 @deffn Command {target names}
4421 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4422 @example
4423 foreach t [target names] @{
4424 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4425 @}
4426 @end example
4427 @end deffn
4428
4429 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4430 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4431
4432 @deffn Command targets [name]
4433 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4434 command names are singular.}
4435
4436 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4437 targets in a user friendly form.
4438
4439 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4440 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4441 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4442 @end deffn
4443
4444 @section Target CPU Types
4445 @cindex target type
4446 @cindex CPU type
4447
4448 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4449 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4450 when calling @command{target create}.
4451 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4452 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4453 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4454 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4455 what core-specific commands may be available
4456 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4457 and more.
4458
4459 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4460 since there's a command to list them.
4461
4462 @anchor{targettypes}
4463 @deffn Command {target types}
4464 Lists all supported target types.
4465 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4466
4467 @itemize @bullet
4468 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4469 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4470 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4471 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4472 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4473 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4474 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4475 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4476 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4477 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4478 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4479 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4480 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4481 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4482 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4483 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4484 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4485 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4486 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4487 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4488 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4489 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4490 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4491 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4492 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4493 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4494 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4495 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4496 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4497 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4498 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4499 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4500 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4501 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4502 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4503 @itemize @minus
4504 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4505 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4506 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4507 @end itemize
4508 And two debug interfaces cores:
4509 @itemize @minus
4510 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4511 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4512 @end itemize
4513 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4514 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4515 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4516 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4517 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4518 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4519 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4520 @end itemize
4521 @end deffn
4522
4523 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4524 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4525 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4526 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4527 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4528 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4529 reflect design generations;
4530 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4531 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4532
4533 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4534 @section Target Configuration
4535
4536 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4537 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4538 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4539 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4540 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4541
4542 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4543 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4544 optional parts.
4545 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4546 command, created as part of target creation.
4547
4548 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4549 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4550 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4551 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4552 to be much more board-specific.
4553 The key steps you use might look something like this
4554
4555 @example
4556 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4557 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4558 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4559 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4560 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4561 @end example
4562
4563 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4564 on-chip SRAM.
4565 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4566 writes to target memory;
4567 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4568 GDB memory checksumming;
4569 and more.
4570
4571 @quotation Warning
4572 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4573 inaccessible when application code
4574 (such as an operating system)
4575 enables or disables the MMU.
4576 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4577 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4578 easy access to other addresses needed.
4579 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4580 @end quotation
4581
4582 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4583 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4584 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4585 controllers.
4586 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4587 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4588 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4589
4590 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4591 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4592 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4593 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4594 purposes including additional configuration.
4595
4596 @itemize @bullet
4597 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4598 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4599 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4600 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4601
4602 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4603 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4604 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4605 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4606 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4607 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4608 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4609
4610 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4611 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4612 @end itemize
4613 @end deffn
4614
4615 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4616 The options accepted by this command may also be
4617 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4618 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4619 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4620
4621 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4622 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4623 and changing its endianness.
4624
4625 @itemize @bullet
4626
4627 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4628 used to access this target.
4629
4630 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4631 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4632 create and manage DAP instances.
4633
4634 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4635 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4636
4637 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4638 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4639 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4640 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4641 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4642 same event name assigns only one handler.
4643
4644 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4645 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4646
4647 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4648 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4649 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4650 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4651 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4652 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4653 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4654
4655 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4656 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4657 or virtual address is being used.
4658
4659 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4660 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4661
4662 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4663 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4664 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4665 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4666 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4667
4668 @anchor{rtostype}
4669 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4670 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4671 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4672 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4673 @option{RIOT}
4674 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4675
4676 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4677 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4678 access the target for debugging.
4679
4680 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4681 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4682 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4683 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4684
4685 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4686 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4687 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4688 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4689 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4690
4691 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4692 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4693 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4694 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4695 command @command{gdb_port}.
4696 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4697
4698 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4699 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4700 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4701 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4702 @end itemize
4703 @end deffn
4704
4705 @section Other $target_name Commands
4706 @cindex object command
4707
4708 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4709 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4710
4711 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4712 Once a button is created a button
4713 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4714 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4715 configure it like this:
4716
4717 @example
4718 # Create
4719 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4720 # Modify
4721 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4722 # Query
4723 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4724 # Report
4725 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4726 @end example
4727
4728 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4729 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4730
4731 @example
4732 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4733 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4734 @end example
4735
4736 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4737
4738 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4739 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4740 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4741 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4742 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4743 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4744 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4745 They are not otherwise documented here.
4746 @end deffn
4747
4748 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4749 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4750 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4751 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4752 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4753 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4754 the target side uses raw memory.
4755
4756 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4757 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4758 The script orientation comes from working with data
4759 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4760 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4761 and neither store nor return those values.
4762
4763 @itemize
4764 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4765 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4766 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4767 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4768 @end itemize
4769 @end deffn
4770
4771 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4772 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4773 @command{$target_name configure}
4774 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4775 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4776 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4777 There are a few special cases:
4778
4779 @itemize @bullet
4780 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4781 event named @var{event_name}.
4782 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4783 two parameters.
4784 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4785 This is a special case because this is set using
4786 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4787 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4788 @end itemize
4789
4790 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4791 all the targets you might use something like this:
4792
4793 @example
4794 foreach name [target names] @{
4795 set y [$name cget -endian]
4796 set z [$name cget -type]
4797 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4798 $x $name $y $z]
4799 @}
4800 @end example
4801 @end deffn
4802
4803 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4804 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4805 Displays the current target state:
4806 @code{debug-running},
4807 @code{halted},
4808 @code{reset},
4809 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4810 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4811 @end deffn
4812
4813 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4814 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4815 currently associated with this target.
4816 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4817 @end deffn
4818
4819 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4820 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4821 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4822 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4823 @end deffn
4824
4825 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4826 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4827 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4828 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4829 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4830 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4831 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4832 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4833 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4834 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4835 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4836 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4837 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4838 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4839 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4840 @end deffn
4841
4842 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4843 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4844 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4845 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4846 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4847 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4848 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4849 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4850 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4851 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4852 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4853 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4854 @end deffn
4855
4856 @anchor{targetevents}
4857 @section Target Events
4858 @cindex target events
4859 @cindex events
4860 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4861 For example:
4862 @itemize @bullet
4863 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4864 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4865 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4866 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4867 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4868 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4869 to set up system clocks or
4870 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4871 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4872 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4873 @end itemize
4874
4875 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4876 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4877 @command{target create ... -event}.
4878
4879 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4880 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4881 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4882
4883 @example
4884 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4885 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4886 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4887 @}
4888 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4889 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4890 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4891 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4892 @}
4893 @end example
4894
4895 The following target events are defined:
4896
4897 @itemize @bullet
4898 @item @b{debug-halted}
4899 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4900 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4901 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4902 @item @b{early-halted}
4903 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4904 @item @b{examine-start}
4905 @* Before target examine is called.
4906 @item @b{examine-end}
4907 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4908 @item @b{examine-fail}
4909 @* After target examine fails.
4910 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4911 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4912 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4913 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4914 connect GDB to running target.
4915 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4916 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4917 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4918 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4919 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4920 is in RAM or read only memory.
4921 Default is @code{halt}
4922 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4923 @* When GDB disconnects
4924 @item @b{gdb-end}
4925 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4926 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4927 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4928 @code{reset init})
4929 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4930 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4931 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4932 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4933 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4934 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4935 @item @b{gdb-start}
4936 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4937 @item @b{halted}
4938 @* The target has halted
4939 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4940 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4941 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4942 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4943 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4944 @item @b{reset-assert}
4945 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4946 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4947 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4948 it instead of asserting SRST.
4949 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4950 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4951 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4952 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4953 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4954 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4955 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4956 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4957 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4958 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4959 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4960 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4961 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4962 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4963 released on the scan chain.
4964 @item @b{reset-end}
4965 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4966 @item @b{reset-init}
4967 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4968 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4969
4970 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4971 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4972 multiplexing, and so on.
4973 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4974 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4975 @item @b{reset-start}
4976 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4977 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4978
4979 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4980 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4981 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4982 @item @b{resume-start}
4983 @* Before any target is resumed
4984 @item @b{resume-end}
4985 @* After all targets have resumed
4986 @item @b{resumed}
4987 @* Target has resumed
4988 @item @b{step-start}
4989 @* Before a target is single-stepped
4990 @item @b{step-end}
4991 @* After single-step has completed
4992 @item @b{trace-config}
4993 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4994 @end itemize
4995
4996 @node Flash Commands
4997 @chapter Flash Commands
4998
4999 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5000 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5001 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5002 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5003 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5004 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5005 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5006 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5007 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5008
5009 Flash Steps:
5010 @enumerate
5011 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5012 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5013 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5014 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5015 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5016 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5017 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5018 @item GDB Flashing
5019 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5020 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5021 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5022 @end enumerate
5023
5024 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5025 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5026 so that it can't boot.
5027 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5028 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5029
5030 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5031 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5032 @cindex flash configuration
5033
5034 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5035 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5036 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5037 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5038 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5039 see the driver-specific documentation.
5040
5041 @itemize @bullet
5042 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5043 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5044 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5045 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5046 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5047 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5048 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5049 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5050 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5051 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5052 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5053 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5054 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5055 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5056 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5057 commands to the flash controller.
5058 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5059 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5060 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5061 for more information.
5062 @end itemize
5063 @quotation Note
5064 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5065 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5066 @end quotation
5067 @end deffn
5068
5069 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5070 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5071 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5072 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5073 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5074 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5075 @end deffn
5076
5077 @deffn Command {flash list}
5078 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5079 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5080 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5081 @end deffn
5082
5083 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5084 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5085 depends on the flash type.
5086 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5087 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5088 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5089 but most don't bother.
5090 @end deffn
5091
5092 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5093
5094 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5095 begins.
5096
5097 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5098 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5099 until the programming session is finished.
5100
5101 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5102 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5103
5104 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5105
5106 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5107 @cindex flash erasing
5108 @cindex flash reading
5109 @cindex flash writing
5110 @cindex flash programming
5111 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5112
5113 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5114 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5115 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5116 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5117 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5118
5119 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5120 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5121 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5122 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5123 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5124
5125 @quotation Note
5126 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5127 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5128 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5129 back to a flash bank.
5130 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5131 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5132 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5133 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5134 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5135 @end quotation
5136
5137 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5138 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5139 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5140 disabled first.
5141 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5142 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5143 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5144
5145 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5146 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5147 up to and including @var{last}.
5148 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5149 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5150 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5151 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5152 @end deffn
5153
5154 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5155 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5156 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5157 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5158 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5159 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5160 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5161 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5162 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5163 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5164 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5165 before erase starts.
5166 @end deffn
5167
5168 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5169 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5170 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5171 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5172 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5173 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5174 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5175 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5176 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5177 before issuing this command.
5178 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5179 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5180 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5181 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5182 @end deffn
5183 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5184
5185 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5186 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5187 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5188 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5189 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5190 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5191 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5192 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5193 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5194 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5195 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5196 @end deffn
5197
5198 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5199 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5200 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5201 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5202 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5203 @end deffn
5204
5205 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5206 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5207 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5208 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5209 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5210 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5211 @end deffn
5212
5213 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5214 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5215 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5216 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5217 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5218 @end deffn
5219
5220 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5221 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5222 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5223 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5224 to the base address for each section in the image.
5225 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5226 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5227 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5228 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5229 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5230 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5231 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5232 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5233 each image section.
5234
5235 @quotation Warning
5236 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5237 data you want to preserve.
5238 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5239 sections might be erased with no notice.
5240 @itemize
5241 @item
5242 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5243 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5244 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5245 @item
5246 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5247 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5248 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5249 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5250 @end itemize
5251 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5252 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5253 @end quotation
5254
5255 @end deffn
5256
5257 @section Other Flash commands
5258 @cindex flash protection
5259
5260 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5261 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5262 and display that status.
5263 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5264 @end deffn
5265
5266 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5267 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5268 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5269
5270 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5271 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5272 and possibly stale information.
5273 @end deffn
5274
5275 @anchor{flashprotect}
5276 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5277 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5278 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5279 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5280 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5281 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5282 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5283 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5284 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5285 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5286 @end deffn
5287
5288 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5289 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5290 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5291 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5292 @end deffn
5293
5294 @anchor{program}
5295 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5296 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5297 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5298 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5299 @end deffn
5300
5301 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5302 @section Flash Driver List
5303 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5304 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5305 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5306
5307 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5308 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5309 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5310
5311 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5312
5313 @itemize
5314 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5315 @end itemize
5316
5317 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5318 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5319 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5320 @example
5321 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5322 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5323 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5324 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5325 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5326 @end example
5327 @end deffn
5328
5329 @subsection External Flash
5330
5331 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5332 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5333 @cindex CFI
5334 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5335 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5336 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5337 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5338 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5339 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5340 configure a bus and its timings), or
5341 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5342 on the flash chip.
5343 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5344 speed up operation.
5345
5346 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5347
5348 @itemize
5349 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5350 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5351 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5352 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5353 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5354 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5355 @end itemize
5356
5357 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5358 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5359
5360 @example
5361 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5362 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5363 @end example
5364
5365 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5366 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5367 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5368
5369 @example
5370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5371 @end example
5372
5373 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5374 @end deffn
5375
5376 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5377 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5378 @cindex SPI
5379 @cindex jtagspi
5380 @cindex bscan_spi
5381 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5382 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5383 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5384 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5385 accessed through JTAG.
5386
5387 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5388 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5389 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5390 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5391 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5392 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5393
5394 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5395 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5396 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5397 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5398 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5399 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5400 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5401 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5402
5403 @itemize
5404 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5405 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5406 @var{USER1} instruction.
5407 @end itemize
5408
5409 @example
5410 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5411 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5413 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5414 @end example
5415 @end deffn
5416
5417 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5418 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5419 @cindex xcf
5420 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5421 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5422 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5423 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5424 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5425
5426 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5427 command accepts additional parameters:
5428 @itemize
5429 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5430 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5431 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5432 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5433 in master mode.
5434 @end itemize
5435 @example
5436 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5437 @end example
5438 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5439 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5440 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5441 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5442 dedicated sector.
5443 @end deffn
5444
5445 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5446 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5447 button.
5448 @example
5449 xcf configure 0
5450 @end example
5451 @end deffn
5452
5453 Additional driver notes:
5454 @itemize
5455 @item Only single revision supported.
5456 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5457 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5458 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5459 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5460 @end itemize
5461 @end deffn
5462
5463 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5464 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5465 @cindex SPIFI
5466 @cindex lpcspifi
5467 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5468 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5469 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5470
5471 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5472 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5473 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5474 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5475 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5476
5477 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5478 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5479 are configured by the driver.
5480
5481 @example
5482 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5483 @end example
5484
5485 @end deffn
5486
5487 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5488 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5489 @cindex SMI
5490 @cindex stmsmi
5491 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5492 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5493 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5494 SPI flash devices.
5495 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5496 flash devices can be connected.
5497
5498 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5499 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5500 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5501 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5502 the flash content.
5503
5504 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5505 to identify the memory bank.
5506 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5507 flash size, are detected automatically.
5508
5509 @example
5510 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5511 @end example
5512
5513 @end deffn
5514
5515 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5516 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5517 Microcontroller platform.
5518
5519 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5520 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5521
5522 @example
5523 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5524 @end example
5525
5526 @end deffn
5527
5528 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5529 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5530 @cindex ath79
5531 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5532 chip selects.
5533 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5534 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5535 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5536 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5537 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5538 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5539
5540 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5541 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5542 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5543 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5544 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5545 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5546 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5547 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5548 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5549 with the default CS0.
5550 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5551 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5552 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5553
5554 @example
5555 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5556
5557 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5558 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5559 # banks.
5560 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5561 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5562 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5563 @end example
5564
5565 @end deffn
5566
5567 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5568 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5569 @cindex fespi
5570
5571 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5572
5573 @example
5574 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5575 @end example
5576 @end deffn
5577
5578 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5579
5580 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5581 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5582 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5583 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5584 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5585 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5586
5587 @example
5588 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5589 @end example
5590 @end deffn
5591
5592 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5593 @cindex ambiqmicro
5594 @cindex apollo
5595 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5596 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5597 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5598 with the target using SWD.
5599
5600 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5601 the device class of the MCU.
5602 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5603 to set up the flash banks.
5604 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5605 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5606
5607 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5608 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5609 and the second bank starts after the first.
5610
5611 @example
5612 # Flash bank 0
5613 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5614 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5615 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5616 $_TARGETNAME
5617 @end example
5618
5619 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5620 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5621 are available to the user.
5622
5623 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5624
5625 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5626 Erase entire bank.
5627 @end deffn
5628 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5629 Erase device pages.
5630 @end deffn
5631 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5632 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5633 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5634 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5635 the flash.
5636 @end deffn
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @anchor{at91samd}
5640 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5641 @cindex at91samd
5642 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5643 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5644
5645 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5646
5647 The devices have one flash bank:
5648
5649 @example
5650 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5651 @end example
5652
5653 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5654 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5655 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5656 processor to be halted.
5657 @end deffn
5658
5659 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5660 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5661 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5662 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5663 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5664 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5665
5666 @example
5667 at91samd set-security enable
5668 @end example
5669 @end deffn
5670
5671 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5672 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5673 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5674 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5675 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5676 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5677 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5678 in order to disable this feature.
5679
5680 @example
5681 at91samd eeprom
5682 at91samd eeprom 1024
5683 @end example
5684 @end deffn
5685
5686 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5687 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5688 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5689 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5690 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5691 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5692
5693 @example
5694 at91samd bootloader
5695 at91samd bootloader 16384
5696 @end example
5697 @end deffn
5698
5699 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5700 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5701 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5702 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5703 @end deffn
5704
5705 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5706 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5707 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5708 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5709 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5710 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5711 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5712 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5713
5714 @example
5715 # Read user row
5716 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5717 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5718 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5719 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5720 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5721 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5722 @end example
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @end deffn
5726
5727 @anchor{at91sam3}
5728 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5729 @cindex at91sam3
5730 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5731 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5732 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5733 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5734 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5735 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5736 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5737 chips are confirmed.}
5738
5739 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5740 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5741 the following fixed locations:
5742
5743 @example
5744 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5745 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5746 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5748 @end example
5749
5750 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5751 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5752 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5753
5754 @itemize
5755 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5756 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5757 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5758 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5759 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5760 @end itemize
5761
5762 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5763
5764 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5765 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5766 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5767 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5768 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5769 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5770 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5771
5772 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5773 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5774 @end deffn
5775
5776 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5777 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5778 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5779 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5780 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5781 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5782 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5783 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5784 @end deffn
5785
5786 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5787 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5788 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5789 @end deffn
5790 @end deffn
5791
5792 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5793 @cindex at91sam4
5794 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5795 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5796 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5797 @end deffn
5798
5799 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5800 @cindex at91sam4l
5801 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5802 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5803 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5804
5805 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5806 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5807 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5808 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5809 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5810 @end deffn
5811 @end deffn
5812
5813 @anchor{atsame5}
5814 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5815 @cindex atsame5
5816 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5817 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5818 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5819
5820 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5821 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5822 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5823
5824 @example
5825 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5826 @end example
5827
5828 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5829 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5830 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5831 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5832 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5833 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5834
5835 @example
5836 atsame5 bootloader
5837 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5838 @end example
5839 @end deffn
5840
5841 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5842 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5843 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5844 processor to be halted.
5845 @end deffn
5846
5847 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5848 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5849 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5850 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5851 @end deffn
5852
5853 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5854 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5855 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5856 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5857 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5858 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5859 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5860 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5861
5862 @example
5863 # Read
5864 >atsame5 userpage
5865 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5866 # Write
5867 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5868 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5869 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5870 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5871 @end example
5872 @end deffn
5873
5874 @end deffn
5875
5876 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5877 @cindex atsamv
5878 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5879 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5880 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5881 @end deffn
5882
5883 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5884 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5885 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5886 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5887 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5888
5889 @example
5890 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5891 @end example
5892
5893 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5894 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5895
5896 @itemize
5897 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5898 @item @var{banks}
5899 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5900 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5901 @item @var{pages_size}
5902 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5903 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5904 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5905 @end itemize
5906
5907 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5908 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5909 will be autoconfigured.
5910 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5911
5912 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5913 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5914 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5915 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5916 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5917
5918 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5919 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5920 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5921 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5922 are not truly general purpose).
5923 @quotation Note
5924 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5925 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5926 @end quotation
5927 @end deffn
5928 @end deffn
5929
5930 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5931 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5932 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5933 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5934 @end deffn
5935
5936 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5937 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
5938 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5939 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5940
5941 @example
5942 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5943 @end example
5944
5945 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5946 each single sector one by one.
5947
5948 @example
5949 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
5950 @end example
5951
5952 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5953 @end deffn
5954
5955 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5956 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5957 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5958 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5959 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5960 starts at address 0.
5961
5962 @example
5963 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5964 @end example
5965 @end deffn
5966
5967 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5968 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5969 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5970 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5971 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5972 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5973 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5974 and programming the serial flash.
5975
5976 @example
5977 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5978 @end example
5979 @end deffn
5980
5981 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5982 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5983 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5984 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5985 autoconfigures itself.
5986 @example
5987 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5988 @end example
5989 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5990 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5991 this via the following command:
5992 @example
5993 efm32 debuglock num
5994 @end example
5995 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5996 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5997 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5998 supported.}
5999 @end deffn
6000
6001 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6002 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6003 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6004 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6005 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6006 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6007
6008 @example
6009 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6010 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6011 @end example
6012
6013 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6014 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6015 @end deffn
6016
6017 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6018 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6019 is an uncommon operation.}
6020 @end deffn
6021 @end deffn
6022
6023 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6024 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6025 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6026 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6027 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6028 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6029 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6030
6031 @example
6032 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6033 @end example
6034 @end deffn
6035
6036 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6037 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6038 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6039 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6040 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6041 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6042 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6043 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6044 characters) ignored.
6045
6046 @example
6047 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6048 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6049 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6050 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6051 @end example
6052 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6053 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6054 @end deffn
6055
6056 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6057 @cindex kinetis
6058 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6059 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6060 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6061 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6062 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6063 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6064
6065 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6066 @itemize
6067 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6068 @end itemize
6069
6070 @example
6071 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6072 @end example
6073
6074 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6075 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6076 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6077 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6078 @end deffn
6079
6080 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6081 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6082 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6083 set by 'flash protect' command.
6084 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6085 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6086 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6087 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6088 with the rest of a flash image.
6089 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6090 @end deffn
6091
6092 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6093 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6094 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6095 @end deffn
6096
6097 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6098 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6099 and examine-fail event.
6100 @end deffn
6101
6102 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6103 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6104 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6108 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6109 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6110 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6111 command completes.
6112 @end deffn
6113
6114 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6115 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6116 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6117 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6118 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6119
6120 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6121 Program Partition command.
6122
6123 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6124 Reset the device after partition setting.
6125
6126 Show partition size:
6127 @example
6128 kinetis nvm_partition info
6129 @end example
6130
6131 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6132 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6133 @example
6134 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6135 @end example
6136
6137 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6138 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6139 @example
6140 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6141 @end example
6142 @end deffn
6143
6144 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6145 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6146 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6147 @end deffn
6148
6149 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6150 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6151 Command disables watchdog timer.
6152 @end deffn
6153 @end deffn
6154
6155 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6156 @cindex kinetis_ke
6157 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6158 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6159 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6160 autoconfigures itself.
6161 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6162
6163 @example
6164 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6165 @end example
6166
6167 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6168 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6169 @end deffn
6170
6171 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6172 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6173 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6174 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6175 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6176 @end deffn
6177
6178 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6179 Command disables watchdog timer.
6180 @end deffn
6181 @end deffn
6182
6183 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6184 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6185 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6186 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6187 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6188
6189 @quotation Note
6190 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6191 driver:
6192 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6193 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6194 @end quotation
6195
6196 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6197 which must appear in the following order:
6198
6199 @itemize
6200 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6201 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6202 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6203 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6204 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6205 LPC43x[2357])
6206 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6207 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6208 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6209 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6210 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6211 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6212 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6213 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6214 at which the core is running
6215 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6216 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6217 @quotation Note
6218 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6219 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6220 However, if you do provide it,
6221 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6222 @end quotation
6223 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6224 ROM IAP entry point.
6225 @end itemize
6226
6227 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6228
6229 @example
6230 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6231 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6232 @end example
6233
6234 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6235 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6236 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6237 @end deffn
6238 @end deffn
6239
6240 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6241 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6242 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6243 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6244 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6245 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6246
6247 @example
6248 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6249 @end example
6250 @end deffn
6251
6252 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6253 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6254 from NXP.
6255
6256 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6257 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6258 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6259 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6260 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6261 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6262 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6263 you start the PLL.
6264
6265 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6266
6267 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6268 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6269 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6270
6271 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6272 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6273 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6274 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6275 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6276 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6277 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6278
6279 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6280 @example
6281 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6282 @end example
6283
6284 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6285 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6286 @code{flash banks} command.
6287
6288 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6289 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6290 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6291 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6292 a known signature.
6293 Example:
6294 @example
6295 lpc2900 signature 0
6296 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6297 @end example
6298 @end deffn
6299
6300 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6301 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6302 saves it to a file in binary format.
6303 Example:
6304 @example
6305 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6306 @end example
6307 @end deffn
6308
6309 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6310 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6311 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6312 command:
6313
6314 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6315 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6316 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6317 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6318
6319 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6320 Example:
6321 @example
6322 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6323 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6324 @end example
6325 @end deffn
6326
6327 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6328 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6329 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6330 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6331 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6332 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6333 912 bytes.
6334 @quotation Attention
6335 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6336 @end quotation
6337 Example:
6338 @example
6339 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6340 @end example
6341 @end deffn
6342
6343 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6344 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6345 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6346 after the next power cycle.
6347 @quotation Attention
6348 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6349 @end quotation
6350 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6351 Example:
6352 @example
6353 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6354 flash info 0
6355 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6356 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6357 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6358 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6359 @end example
6360 @end deffn
6361
6362 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6363 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6364 effective after the next power cycle.
6365 @quotation Attention
6366 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6367 @end quotation
6368 Examples:
6369 @example
6370 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6371 @end example
6372 @end deffn
6373 @end deffn
6374
6375 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6376 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6377 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6378 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6379
6380 @example
6381 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6382 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6383 @end example
6384
6385 @itemize @bullet
6386 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6387 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6388 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6389 @end itemize
6390
6391 Example usage:
6392 @example
6393 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6394 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6395 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6396 @} else @{
6397 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6398 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6399 @}
6400 @end example
6401 @end deffn
6402
6403 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6404 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6405 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6406 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6407 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6408 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6409
6410 @example
6411 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6412 @end example
6413
6414 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6415 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6416 only the main program flash.
6417
6418 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6419 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6420 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6424 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6425 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6426 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6427
6428 To erase and program the BSL:
6429 @example
6430 msp432 bsl unlock
6431 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6432 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6433 msp432 bsl lock
6434 @end example
6435 @end deffn
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6439 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6440 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6441 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6442 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6443 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6444 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6445 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6446 also have division into regions: main and info.
6447 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6448 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6449
6450 @example
6451 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6452 @end example
6453
6454 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6455
6456 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6457 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6458 @end deffn
6459
6460 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6461 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6462 @end deffn
6463
6464 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6465 Erase all userflash including info region.
6466 @end deffn
6467
6468 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6469 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6470 @end deffn
6471
6472 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6473 Check sectors protect.
6474 @end deffn
6475
6476 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6477 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6481 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6482 @end deffn
6483
6484 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6485 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6486 @end deffn
6487
6488 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6489 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6490 @end deffn
6491
6492 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6493 Show information about flash driver.
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @end deffn
6497
6498 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6499 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6500 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6501 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6502 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6503
6504 @example
6505 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6506 @end example
6507
6508 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6509
6510 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6511 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6512 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6513 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6514 code.
6515 @end deffn
6516
6517 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6518 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6519 @end deffn
6520
6521 @end deffn
6522
6523 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6524 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6525 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6526
6527 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6528 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6529 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6530 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6531
6532 @example
6533 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6534 @end example
6535 @end deffn
6536
6537 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6538 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6539 and integrate flash memory.
6540
6541 @example
6542 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6543 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6544 @end example
6545
6546 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6547 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6548 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6549 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6550 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6551 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6552 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6553 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6554 @end deffn
6555 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6556 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6557 This will remove any Code Protection.
6558 @end deffn
6559 @end deffn
6560
6561 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6562 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6563 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6564 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6565 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6566
6567 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6568 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6569
6570 @example
6571 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6572 @end example
6573
6574 psoc4-specific commands
6575 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6576 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6577
6578 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6579 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6580
6581 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6582 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6583 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6584
6585 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6586 @end deffn
6587
6588 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6589 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6590
6591 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6592 @end deffn
6593 @end deffn
6594
6595 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6596 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6597 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6598 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6599 apart from the base address.
6600
6601 @example
6602 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6603 @end example
6604
6605 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6606 @quotation Attention
6607 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6608 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6609 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6610 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6611 @end quotation
6612
6613 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6614
6615 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6616 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6617 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6618 @end deffn
6619 @end deffn
6620
6621 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6622 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6623 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6624 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6625 apart from the base address.
6626
6627 @example
6628 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6629 @end example
6630 @end deffn
6631
6632 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6633 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6634 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6635 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6636
6637 @example
6638 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6639 @end example
6640
6641 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6642
6643 @itemize
6644 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6645 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6646 @end itemize
6647
6648 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6649
6650 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6651 @quotation Attention
6652 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6653 after successful write.
6654 @end quotation
6655 @end deffn
6656
6657 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6658 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6659 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6660 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6661
6662 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6663 @itemize @bullet
6664 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6665 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6666 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6667 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6668 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6669 row size: 512 bytes.
6670 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6671 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6672 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6673 operation will erase row automatically.
6674 @end itemize
6675
6676 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6677 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6678
6679 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6680
6681 @example
6682 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6683 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6684 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6685 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6686 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6687 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6688
6689 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6690 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6691 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6692 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6693 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6694 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6695 @end example
6696
6697 psoc6-specific commands
6698 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6699 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6700 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6701 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6702 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6703 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6704 @end deffn
6705
6706 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6707 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6708 by @command{flash banks}.
6709 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6710 @end deffn
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6714 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6715 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6716 and SWD interface.
6717 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6718 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6719
6720 @example
6721 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6722 @end example
6723
6724 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6725
6726 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6727 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6728 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6729 @end deffn
6730
6731 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6732 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6733 @end deffn
6734 @end deffn
6735
6736 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6737 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6738 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6739 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6740 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6741
6742 @example
6743 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6744 @end example
6745
6746 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6747 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6748 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6749 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6750 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6751 disabled.
6752
6753 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6754 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6755 @quotation Warning
6756 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6757 applied to all of them.
6758 @end quotation
6759 @end deffn
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6763 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6764 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6765 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6766 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6767
6768 @example
6769 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6770 @end example
6771
6772 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6773 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6774 the flash driver.
6775
6776 @example
6777 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6778 @end example
6779
6780 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6781 as per the following example.
6782 @example
6783 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6784 @end example
6785
6786 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6787
6788 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6789 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6790 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6791 @end deffn
6792
6793 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6794 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6795 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6796 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6800 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6801 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6802 @end deffn
6803
6804 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6805 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6806 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6807 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6808 @end deffn
6809
6810 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6811 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6812 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6813 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6814 @end deffn
6815
6816 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6817 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6818 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6819 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6820 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6821 @end deffn
6822 @end deffn
6823
6824 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6825 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6826 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6827 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6828 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6829
6830 @example
6831 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6832 @end example
6833
6834 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6835 as per the following example.
6836 @example
6837 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6838 @end example
6839
6840 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6841 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6842 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6846 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6847 the flash driver.
6848
6849 @example
6850 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6851 @end example
6852
6853 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6854
6855 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6856 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6857 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6858 @end deffn
6859
6860 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6861 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6862 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6863 @end deffn
6864
6865 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6866 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6867 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6868 @end deffn
6869
6870 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6871 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6872 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6873 @end deffn
6874
6875 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6876 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6877 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6878 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6879 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6880 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6881 @end deffn
6882
6883 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6884 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6885 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6886 @end deffn
6887 @end deffn
6888
6889 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6890 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6891 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6892 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6893 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6894
6895 @example
6896 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6897 @end example
6898
6899 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6900 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6901 the flash driver.
6902
6903 @example
6904 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6905 @end example
6906
6907 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6908
6909 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6910 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6911 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6912 @end deffn
6913
6914 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6915 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6916 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6917 @end deffn
6918
6919 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6920 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6921 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6922 @end deffn
6923
6924 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6925 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6926 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6927 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6928 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6929
6930 Example usage:
6931 @example
6932 # read OPTSR_CUR
6933 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6934 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6935 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6936 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6937 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6938 @end example
6939 @end deffn
6940
6941 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6942 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6943 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6944 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6945 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6946 will be touched).
6947
6948 Example usage:
6949 @example
6950 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6951 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6952 @end example
6953 @end deffn
6954 @end deffn
6955
6956 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6957 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6958 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6959 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6960 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6961
6962 @example
6963 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6964 @end example
6965
6966 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6967 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6968 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6969 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6970 second bank.
6971
6972 @example
6973 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6974 @end example
6975
6976 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6977
6978 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6979 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6980 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6981 @end deffn
6982
6983 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6984 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6985 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6986 @end deffn
6987
6988 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6989 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6990 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6991 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6992 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6993 @end deffn
6994 @end deffn
6995
6996 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6997 All members of the STM32L4, STM32L4+, STM32WB, STM32WL and STM32G4
6998 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
6999 and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
7000 Additionally this driver supports STM32G0 family with ARM Cortex-M0+ core.
7001 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7002 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7003
7004 @example
7005 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7006 @end example
7007
7008 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7009 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7010 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7011 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7012
7013 @example
7014 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7015 @end example
7016
7017 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7018
7019 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7020 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7021 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7022 @end deffn
7023
7024 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7025 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7026 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7027 @end deffn
7028
7029 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7030 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7031 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7032 @end deffn
7033
7034 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7035 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7036 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7037 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7038
7039 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7040 @example
7041 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7042 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7043 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7044 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7045 @end example
7046
7047 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7048 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7049 @end deffn
7050
7051 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7052 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7053 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7054 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7055 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7056
7057 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7058 @example
7059 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7060 @end example
7061
7062 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7063 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7064 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7065 @end deffn
7066
7067 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7068 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7069 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7070 @end deffn
7071 @end deffn
7072
7073 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7074 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7075 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7076 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7077 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7078
7079 @example
7080 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7081 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7082 @end example
7083
7084 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7085 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7086 for the specified flash bank.
7087 @end deffn
7088 @end deffn
7089
7090 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7091 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7092 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7093 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7094 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7095
7096 @example
7097 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7098 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7099 @end example
7100
7101 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7102 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7103 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7104
7105 @itemize @bullet
7106 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7107 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7108 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7109 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7110 @end itemize
7111 @end deffn
7112
7113 @end deffn
7114
7115 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7116 @cindex str9xpec
7117
7118 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7119 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7120 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7121 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7122
7123 Here is some background info to help
7124 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7125 the str9:
7126 @enumerate
7127 @item
7128 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7129 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7130 @item
7131 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7132 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7133 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7134 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7135 @end enumerate
7136
7137 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7138 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7139 configured for flash bank 0.
7140 @example
7141 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7142 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7143 adapter assert srst
7144 # turn off target polling
7145 poll off
7146 # disable str9 core
7147 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7148 # read option bytes
7149 str9xpec options_read 0
7150 # re-enable str9 core
7151 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7152 poll on
7153 reset halt
7154 @end example
7155 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7156 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7157 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7158 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7159
7160 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7161
7162 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7163 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7164 @end deffn
7165
7166 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7167 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7168 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7172 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7173 erase the device.
7174 @end deffn
7175
7176 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7177 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7178 @end deffn
7179
7180 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7181 Configure str9 boot bank.
7182 @end deffn
7183
7184 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7185 Configure str9 lvd source.
7186 @end deffn
7187
7188 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7189 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7190 @end deffn
7191
7192 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7193 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7194 @end deffn
7195
7196 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7197 Read str9 option bytes.
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7201 Write str9 option bytes.
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7205 unlock str9 device.
7206 @end deffn
7207
7208 @end deffn
7209
7210 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7211 @cindex swm050
7212 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7213
7214 @example
7215 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7216 @end example
7217
7218 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7219
7220 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7221 Erases the entire flash bank.
7222 @end deffn
7223
7224 @end deffn
7225
7226
7227 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7228 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7229 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7230 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7231
7232 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7233
7234 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7235 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7236 @end deffn
7237
7238 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7239 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7240 @end deffn
7241
7242 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7243 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7244 the flash clock.
7245 @end deffn
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7249 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7250 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7251 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7252 correct bank config.
7253
7254 @example
7255 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7256 @end example
7257 @end deffn
7258
7259 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7260 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7261 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7262 @end deffn
7263
7264 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7265 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7266 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7267
7268 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7269
7270 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7271 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7272 @end deffn
7273
7274 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7275 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7276 @end deffn
7277
7278 @end deffn
7279
7280 @section NAND Flash Commands
7281 @cindex NAND
7282
7283 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7284 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7285 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7286
7287 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7288 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7289 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7290 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7291 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7292 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7293
7294 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7295 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7296 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7297 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7298 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7299 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7300 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7301 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7302 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7303 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7304
7305 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7306 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7307 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7308 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7309 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7310 every 512 bytes of data.
7311
7312 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7313 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7314 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7315 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7316 ECC mode is used.
7317
7318 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7319 @enumerate
7320 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7321 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7322 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7323 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7324 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7325 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7326 to access that device.
7327 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7328 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7329 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7330 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7331 de-brick a board.
7332 @end enumerate
7333
7334 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7335 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7336 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7337 are only 32 bits wide.
7338 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7339 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7340 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7341 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7342
7343 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7344 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7345 @cindex NAND configuration
7346
7347 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7348 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7349 OpenOCD has initialized.
7350
7351 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7352 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7353 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7354 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7355 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7356 they were a single (larger) device.
7357 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7358 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7359
7360 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7361 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7362 configuration files, not interactively.
7363
7364 @itemize @bullet
7365 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7366 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7367 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7368 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7369 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7370 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7371 commands to the NAND controller.
7372 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7373 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7374 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7375 for more information.
7376 @end itemize
7377 @end deffn
7378
7379 @deffn Command {nand list}
7380 Prints a summary of each device declared
7381 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7382 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7383 @example
7384 > nand list
7385 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7386 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7387 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7388 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7389 >
7390 @end example
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7394 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7395 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7396 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7397 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7398 it with most other NAND commands.
7399 @end deffn
7400
7401 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7402
7403 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7404 @cindex NAND reading
7405 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7406 starting at the specified offset.
7407 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7408
7409 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7410 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7411
7412 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7413 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7414 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7415
7416 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7417 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7418 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7419 method which handled that error correction.
7420
7421 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7422 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7423 @itemize @bullet
7424 @item no oob_* parameter
7425 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7426 @item @code{oob_raw}
7427 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7428 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7429 spare areas associated with each data page.
7430 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7431 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7432 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7433 @item @code{oob_only}
7434 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7435 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7436 spare areas associated with each data page.
7437 @end itemize
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7441 @cindex NAND erasing
7442 @cindex NAND programming
7443 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7444 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7445 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7446 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7447 If those parameters are not specified,
7448 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7449 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7450
7451 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7452 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7453 block marker.
7454 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7455 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7459 @cindex NAND writing
7460 @cindex NAND programming
7461 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7462 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7463 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7464 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7465
7466 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7467 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7468
7469 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7470 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7471 past the end of the device.
7472 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7473 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7474 if that's being written.)
7475
7476 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7477 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7478 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7479
7480 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7481 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7482 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7483 @itemize @bullet
7484 @item no oob_* parameter
7485 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7486 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7487 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7488 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7489 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7490 @item @code{oob_only}
7491 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7492 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7493 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7494 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7495 @item @code{oob_raw}
7496 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7497 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7498 un-altered OOB.
7499 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7500 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7501 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7502 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7503 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7504 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7505 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7506 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7507 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7508 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7509 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7510 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7511 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7512 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7513 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7514 @end itemize
7515 @end deffn
7516
7517 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7518 @cindex NAND verification
7519 @cindex NAND programming
7520 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7521 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7522 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7523
7524 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7525 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7526
7527 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7528 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7529 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7530 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7531 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7532
7533 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7534 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7535 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7536
7537 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7538 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7539 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7540 be removed in a future release.
7541 @end deffn
7542
7543 @subsection Other NAND commands
7544 @cindex NAND other commands
7545
7546 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7547 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7548 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7549 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7550 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7551 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7552 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7553 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7554
7555 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7556 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7557 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7558 @end deffn
7559
7560 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7561 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7562 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7563 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7564 status for each block.
7565 @end deffn
7566
7567 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7568 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7569 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7570
7571 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7572 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7573 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7574 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7575 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7576
7577 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7578 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7579 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7580 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7581 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7582 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7583 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7584 @end deffn
7585
7586 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7587 @subsection NAND Driver List
7588 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7589 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7590 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7591
7592 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7593 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7594 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7595 address of the ECC controller.
7596 @example
7597 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7598 @end example
7599 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7600 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7601 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7602 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7603 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7604 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7605 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7606 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7607 @end deffn
7608 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7609 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7610 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7611 @end deffn
7612
7613 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7614 properly configured for input or output.
7615 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7616 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7617 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7618 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7619 @end deffn
7620 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7621 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7622 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7623 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7624 @end deffn
7625 @end deffn
7626
7627 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7628 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7629 chips from Texas Instruments.
7630 It takes three extra parameters:
7631 address of the NAND chip;
7632 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7633 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7634 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7635 @example
7636 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7637 @end example
7638 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7639 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7640 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7641 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7642 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7643 @end deffn
7644
7645 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7646 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7647 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7648 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7649 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7650 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7651 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7652 @end deffn
7653
7654 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7655 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7656 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7657 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7658 @end deffn
7659 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7660
7661 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7662 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7663 should work for this chip as well.
7664 @end deffn
7665
7666 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7667 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7668 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7669 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7670 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7671 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7672 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7673 @example
7674 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7675 @end example
7676 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7677 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7678 without parameter query status.
7679 @end deffn
7680 @end deffn
7681
7682 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7683 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7684 parameter: the address of the controller.
7685 @example
7686 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7687 @end example
7688 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7689 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7690 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7691 change any behavior.
7692 @end deffn
7693
7694 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7695 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7696 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7697 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7698 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7699 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7700 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7701 specialized commands.
7702 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7703 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7704 change any behavior.
7705 @end deffn
7706
7707 @node Flash Programming
7708 @chapter Flash Programming
7709
7710 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7711 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7712 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7713
7714 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7715 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7716
7717 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7718 @enumerate
7719 @item 'init' is executed.
7720 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7721 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7722 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7723 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7724 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7725 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7726 @end enumerate
7727
7728 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7729
7730 @example
7731 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7732 # are optional parameters
7733 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7734 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7735
7736 # binary files need the flash address passing
7737 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7738 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7739 @end example
7740
7741 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7742 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7743 @cindex PLD
7744 @cindex FPGA
7745
7746 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7747 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7748 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7749 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7750 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7751 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7752 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7753
7754 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7755
7756 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7757 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7758 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7759
7760 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7761 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7762
7763 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7764 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7765 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7766 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7767 behavior.
7768 @end deffn
7769
7770 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7771 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7772 @end deffn
7773
7774 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7775 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7776 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7777 @end deffn
7778
7779 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7780
7781 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7782 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7783 that particular type of PLD.
7784
7785 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7786 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7787 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7788
7789 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7790 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7791 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7792
7793 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7794 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7795 for FPGA @var{num}.
7796 @end deffn
7797 @end deffn
7798
7799 @node General Commands
7800 @chapter General Commands
7801 @cindex commands
7802
7803 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7804 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7805 commands are documented elsewhere.
7806
7807 Intent:
7808 @itemize @bullet
7809 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7810 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7811 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7812 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7813
7814 @item @b{From the human}
7815 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7816 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7817
7818 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7819 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7820 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7821
7822 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7823 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7824 port is 5555.
7825 @end itemize
7826
7827
7828 @section Server Commands
7829
7830 @deffn {Command} exit
7831 Exits the current telnet session.
7832 @end deffn
7833
7834 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7835 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7836 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7837 Not every command provides helptext.
7838
7839 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7840 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7841 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7842 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7843 @end deffn
7844
7845 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7846 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7847 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7848 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7849 Useful in connection with script files
7850 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7851 @end deffn
7852
7853 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7854 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7855 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7856 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7857
7858 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7859 @example
7860 # redefine shutdown
7861 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7862 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7863 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7864 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7865 original_shutdown
7866 @}
7867 @end example
7868 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7869 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7870 @end deffn
7871
7872 @anchor{debuglevel}
7873 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7874 @cindex message level
7875 Display debug level.
7876 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7877 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7878 Level 0 is error messages only;
7879 level 1 adds warnings;
7880 level 2 adds informational messages;
7881 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7882 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7883 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7884 the command line along with the location of that log
7885 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7886 @xref{Running}.
7887 @end deffn
7888
7889 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7890 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7891 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7892 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7893 @example
7894 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7895 @end example
7896 @end deffn
7897
7898 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
7899 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
7900 the default log output channel is stderr.
7901 @end deffn
7902
7903 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7904 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7908 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7909 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7910 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7911 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7912 @end deffn
7913
7914 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7915 @section Target State handling
7916 @cindex reset
7917 @cindex halt
7918 @cindex target initialization
7919
7920 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7921 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7922 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7923 a current target which is used to perform the
7924 various operations. The current target may be changed
7925 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7926 target which should become current.
7927
7928 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7929 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7930 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7931 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7932 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7933
7934 @emph{With no arguments}:
7935 list all available registers for the current target,
7936 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7937 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7938 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7939 are flagged as such.
7940
7941 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7942 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7943 bypassing any internal cache.
7944
7945 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7946 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7947 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7948 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7949 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7950 relevant module will flush such values.
7951
7952 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7953 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7954
7955 @example
7956 > reg
7957 ===== ARM registers
7958 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7959 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7960 (2) r2 (/32)
7961 ...
7962 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7963 >
7964 @end example
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7968 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7969 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7970 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7971 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7972 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7973 (and enter debug mode).
7974 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7975
7976 @quotation Warning
7977 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7978 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7979 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7980 power mode by gating the core clock;
7981 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7982
7983 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7984 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7985 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7986 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7987 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7988 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7989
7990 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7991 work with a JTAG debugger.
7992 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7993 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7994 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7995 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7996 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7997 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7998 @end quotation
7999
8000 @end deffn
8001
8002 @deffn Command resume [address]
8003 Resume the target at its current code position,
8004 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8005 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8006 @end deffn
8007
8008 @deffn Command step [address]
8009 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8010 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8011 @end deffn
8012
8013 @anchor{resetcommand}
8014 @deffn Command reset
8015 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8016 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8017 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8018 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8019 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8020 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8021
8022 The optional parameter specifies what should
8023 happen after the reset.
8024 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8025 The other options will not work on all systems.
8026 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8027
8028 @itemize @minus
8029 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8030 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8031 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8032 @end itemize
8033 @end deffn
8034
8035 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8036 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8037 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8038 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8039 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8040 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8041 state.
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8045 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8046 Set values of reset signals.
8047 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8048 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8049 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8050 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8051
8052 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8053 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8054 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8055 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8056 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8057 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8058 the signal will not be modified.
8059
8060 @quotation Note
8061 TRST is specially handled.
8062 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8063 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8064 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8065 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8066 instead of the TRST signal.
8067 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8068 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8069 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8070 with handlers for that event.
8071 @end quotation
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @section I/O Utilities
8075
8076 These commands are available when
8077 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8078 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8079 notably the ZY1000.
8080 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8081
8082 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8083
8084 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8085 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8086 the text file @file{filename}.
8087 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8088 The last string is followed by a newline.
8089 @end deffn
8090
8091 @deffn Command cat filename
8092 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8093 @end deffn
8094
8095 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8096 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8097 into @file{dest_filename}.
8098 @end deffn
8099
8100 @deffn Command ip
8101 @emph{No description provided.}
8102 @end deffn
8103
8104 @deffn Command ls
8105 @emph{No description provided.}
8106 @end deffn
8107
8108 @deffn Command mac
8109 @emph{No description provided.}
8110 @end deffn
8111
8112 @deffn Command meminfo
8113 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8114 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8115 @end deffn
8116
8117 @deffn Command peek
8118 @emph{No description provided.}
8119 @end deffn
8120
8121 @deffn Command poke
8122 @emph{No description provided.}
8123 @end deffn
8124
8125 @deffn Command rm filename
8126 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8127 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8128 @end deffn
8129
8130 @deffn Command trunc filename
8131 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8132 @end deffn
8133
8134 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8135 @section Memory access commands
8136 @cindex memory access
8137
8138 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8139 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8140 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8141 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8142
8143 @enumerate
8144 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8145 to change the current target.
8146 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8147 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8148 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8149 @end enumerate
8150
8151 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8152 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8153 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8154 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8155 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8156 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8157 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8158 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8159 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8160 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8161 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8162 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8163 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8164 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8165 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8166 @end deffn
8167
8168 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8169 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8170 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8171 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8172 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8173 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8174 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8175 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8176 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8177 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8178 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8179 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8180 @end deffn
8181
8182 @anchor{imageaccess}
8183 @section Image loading commands
8184 @cindex image loading
8185 @cindex image dumping
8186
8187 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8188 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8189 binary file named @var{filename}.
8190 @end deffn
8191
8192 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8193 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8194 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8195 @end deffn
8196
8197 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8198 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8199 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8200 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8201 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8202 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8203 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8204 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8205 separately.
8206 @end deffn
8207
8208 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8209 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8210 The file format may optionally be specified
8211 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8212 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8213 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8214 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8215 @example
8216 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8217 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8218 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8219 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8220 $address $length
8221 @}
8222 @end example
8223 @end deffn
8224
8225 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8226 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8227 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8228 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8229 The file format may optionally be specified
8230 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8231 @end deffn
8232
8233 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8234 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8235 The file format may optionally be specified
8236 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8237 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8238 @end deffn
8239
8240 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8241 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8242 The file format may optionally be specified
8243 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8244 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8245 @end deffn
8246
8247
8248 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8249 @cindex breakpoint
8250 @cindex watchpoint
8251
8252 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8253 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8254 watchpoints.
8255 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8256
8257 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8258 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8259 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8260 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8261 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8262 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8263
8264 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8265 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8266 @end deffn
8267
8268 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8269 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8270 @end deffn
8271
8272 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8273 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8274 @end deffn
8275
8276 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8277 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8278 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8279 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8280 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8281 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8282 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8283 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8284 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8285 @end deffn
8286
8287 @section Misc Commands
8288
8289 @cindex profiling
8290 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8291 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8292 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8293 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8294 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8295 limit the address range.
8296 @end deffn
8297
8298 @deffn Command {version}
8299 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8300 @end deffn
8301
8302 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8303 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8304 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8305 @end deffn
8306
8307 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8308 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8309 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8310 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8311
8312 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8313 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8314 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8315 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8316
8317 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8318 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8319 @cindex tracing
8320 @cindex ETM
8321 @cindex ETB
8322
8323 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8324 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8325 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8326
8327 @itemize
8328 @item
8329 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8330 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8331 supports such an interface.
8332 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8333 and trace port support.)
8334 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8335 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8336 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8337 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8338 in the board-specific configuration file.
8339 @item
8340 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8341 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8342 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8343 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8344 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8345 @end itemize
8346
8347 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8348
8349 @quotation Issues
8350 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8351 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8352
8353 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8354 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8355 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8356 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8357 dummy trace port driver}.
8358
8359 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8360 as well as tracing only during specific states
8361 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8362
8363 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8364 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8365 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8366 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8367 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8368
8369 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8370 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8371 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8372 this original style of JTAG access.
8373 @end quotation
8374
8375 @subsection ETM Configuration
8376 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8377
8378 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8379 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8380 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8381
8382 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8383 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8384 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8385 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8386 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8387 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8388 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8389 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8390 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8391
8392 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8393 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8394 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8395
8396 @quotation Warning
8397 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8398 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8399 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8400 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8401 @end quotation
8402
8403 @quotation Note
8404 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8405 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8406 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8407 what CPU activities are traced.
8408 @end quotation
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {etm info}
8412 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8413 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8414 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8415 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8416 @end deffn
8417
8418 @deffn Command {etm status}
8419 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8420 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8421 Did trace data overflow?
8422 Was it triggered?
8423 @end deffn
8424
8425 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8426 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8427 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8428 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8429 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8430
8431 @itemize
8432 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8433 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8434 The value is one of
8435 @option{none} (save nothing),
8436 @option{data} (save data),
8437 @option{address} (save addresses),
8438 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8439 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8440 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8441 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8442 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8443 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8444 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8445 trace stream without an image of the code.
8446 @end itemize
8447 @end deffn
8448
8449 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8450 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8451 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8452 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8453 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8454
8455 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8456 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8457 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8458 @end deffn
8459
8460 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8461
8462 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8463 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8464 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8465
8466 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8467 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8468 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8469 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8470 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8471 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8472 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8473
8474 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8475
8476 @itemize
8477 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8478 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8479 for instruction access within that function's body.
8480 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8481 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8482 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8483 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8484 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8485 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8486 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8487 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8488 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8489 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8490 @item @emph{... more}
8491 @end itemize
8492
8493 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8494 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8495
8496 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8497 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8498 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8499 @end deffn
8500
8501 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8502 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8503 @end deffn
8504
8505 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8506 Opens an image file.
8507 @end deffn
8508
8509 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8510 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8511 @end deffn
8512
8513 @deffn Command {etm start}
8514 Starts trace data collection.
8515 @end deffn
8516
8517 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8518 Stops trace data collection.
8519 @end deffn
8520
8521 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8522 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8523
8524 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8525
8526 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8527 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8528 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8529 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8530 any trace data collection.}
8531 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8532 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8533 @end deffn
8534 @end deffn
8535
8536 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8537 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8538 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8539 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8540 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8541 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8542 @end deffn
8543 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8544 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8545 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8546 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8547 trace trigger becomes active.
8548
8549 @itemize
8550 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8551 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8552 afterwards.
8553 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8554 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8555 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8556 what caused that event to happen.
8557 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8558 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8559 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8560 how the event caused trouble.
8561 @end itemize
8562 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8563 @end deffn
8564
8565 @end deffn
8566
8567 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8568 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8569 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8570 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8571 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8572
8573 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8574 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8575
8576 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8577 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8578 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8579 @end deffn
8580
8581 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8582 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8583 @end deffn
8584
8585 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8586 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8587 @end deffn
8588 @end deffn
8589
8590 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8591 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8592 @cindex CTI
8593
8594 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8595 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8596 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8597 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8598 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8599 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8600
8601 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8602 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8603 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8604 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8605 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8606 including additional configuration.
8607 @end deffn
8608
8609 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8610 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8611 @end deffn
8612
8613 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8614 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8615 @end deffn
8616
8617 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8618 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8619 @end deffn
8620
8621 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8622 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8623 @end deffn
8624
8625 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8626 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8627 @end deffn
8628
8629 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8630 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8631 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8632 @end deffn
8633
8634 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8635 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8636 of the CTI.
8637 @end deffn
8638
8639 @deffn Command {cti names}
8640 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8641 useful in TCL scripting.
8642 @end deffn
8643
8644 @section Generic ARM
8645 @cindex ARM
8646
8647 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8648 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8649 commands that may be available.
8650
8651 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8652 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8653 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8654 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8655 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8656 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8657 @end deffn
8658
8659 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8660 @cindex disassemble
8661 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8662 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8663 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8664 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8665 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8666 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8667 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8668
8669 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8670 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8671 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8672 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8673 with a handful of exceptions.
8674 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8675 @end deffn
8676
8677 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8678 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8679 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8680 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8681 and using the MCR instruction.
8682 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8683 an ARM register.)
8684 @end deffn
8685
8686 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8687 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8688 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8689 and the MRC instruction.
8690 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8691 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8692 an ARM register.)
8693 @end deffn
8694
8695 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8696 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8697 core mode if necessary.
8698 @end deffn
8699
8700 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8701 @cindex ARM semihosting
8702 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8703
8704 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8705 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8706 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8707 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8708 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8709 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8710 @end deffn
8711
8712 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8713 @cindex ARM semihosting
8714 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8715
8716 @example
8717 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8718 @end example
8719
8720 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8721 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8722 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8723 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8724 @end deffn
8725
8726 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8727 @cindex ARM semihosting
8728 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8729 status.
8730
8731 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8732 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8733 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8734 debugger.
8735 @end deffn
8736
8737 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8738 @cindex ARM semihosting
8739 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8740
8741 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8742 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8743 the value returned by the target.
8744
8745 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8746 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8747 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8748 encountering a break.
8749
8750 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8751 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8752 to the debugger.
8753 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8754 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8755 request or equivalent").
8756
8757 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8758 this option (default: disabled).
8759 @end deffn
8760
8761 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8762 @cindex ARMv4
8763 @cindex ARMv5
8764
8765 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8766 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8767 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8768 variant.
8769
8770 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8771 @cindex ARM7
8772 @cindex ARM9
8773
8774 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8775 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8776 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8777 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8778
8779 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8780 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8781 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8782 instead of breakpoints.
8783 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8784
8785 This should be
8786 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8787 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8788 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8789 @end deffn
8790
8791 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8792 @cindex DCC
8793 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8794 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8795 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8796
8797 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8798 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8799 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8800 @end deffn
8801
8802 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8803 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8804 that don't check completion of the operation.
8805 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8806
8807 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8808 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8809 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8810 @end deffn
8811
8812 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8813 @cindex ARM720T
8814
8815 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8816 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8817 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8818 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8819
8820 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8821 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8822 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8823
8824 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8825 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8826 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8827 @end deffn
8828
8829 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8830 @cindex ARM9
8831
8832 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8833 integer processors.
8834 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8835
8836 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8837 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8838 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8839 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8840
8841 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8842 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8843 @cindex vector_catch
8844 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8845 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8846 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8847 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8848 to those hardware vectors.
8849
8850 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8851 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8852 vector catch hardware to intercept
8853 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8854 @option{none} of them,
8855 or a list with one or more of the following:
8856 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8857 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8858 @end deffn
8859
8860 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8861 @cindex ARM920T
8862
8863 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8864 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8865 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8866 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8867 and ARM9 commands.
8868
8869 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8870 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8871 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8872 @end deffn
8873
8874 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8875 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8876 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8877 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8878 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8879 (Not all registers can be written.)
8880 @end deffn
8881
8882 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8883 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8884 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8885
8886 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8887 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8888 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8889 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8890 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8891 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8892 @end deffn
8893
8894 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8895 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8896 @end deffn
8897
8898 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8899 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8900 @end deffn
8901
8902 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8903 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8904
8905 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8906 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8907 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8908 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8909 and ARM9 commands.
8910
8911 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8912 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8913
8914 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8915 Print information about the caches found.
8916 @end deffn
8917
8918 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8919 @cindex ARM966E
8920
8921 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8922 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8923 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8924 and ARM9 commands.
8925
8926 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8927 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8928 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8929 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8930 ARM966E-S TRM.
8931 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8932 as required for BIST support.
8933 @end deffn
8934
8935 @subsection XScale specific commands
8936 @cindex XScale
8937
8938 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8939
8940 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8941 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8942 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8943 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8944 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8945 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8946 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8947
8948 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8949 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8950 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8951 the mini-IC.
8952
8953 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8954 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8955 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8956 code layout in memory:
8957 @example
8958 _vectors:
8959 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8960 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8961 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8962 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8963 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8964 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8965 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8966 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8967 .org 0x100
8968 .long real_reset_vector
8969 .long real_ui_handler
8970 .long real_swi_handler
8971 .long real_pf_abort
8972 .long real_data_abort
8973 .long 0 /* unused */
8974 .long real_irq_handler
8975 .long real_fiq_handler
8976 @end example
8977
8978 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8979 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8980 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8981 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8982 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8983 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8984 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8985 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8986 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8987 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8988 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8989 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8990 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8991 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8992 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8993 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8994 software.
8995
8996 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8997 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8998 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8999 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9000
9001 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9002 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9003 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9004 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9005 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9006 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9007 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9008 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9009 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9010
9011 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9012 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9013
9014 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9015 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9016 @end deffn
9017
9018 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9019 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9023 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9024 @end deffn
9025
9026 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9027 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9028 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9029 @end deffn
9030
9031 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9032 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9033 @end deffn
9034
9035 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9036 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9037 @end deffn
9038
9039 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9040 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9041 @end deffn
9042
9043 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9044 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9045 @end deffn
9046
9047 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9048 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9049 @end deffn
9050
9051 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9052 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9053 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9054 and modifying how it is emptied.
9055 @end deffn
9056
9057 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9058 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9059 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9060 The image @var{type} may be one of
9061 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9062 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9063 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9064 @end deffn
9065
9066 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9067 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9068 @cindex vector_catch
9069 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9070 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9071
9072 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9073 @example
9074 0x01 Trap Reset
9075 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9076 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9077 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9078 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9079 0x20 reserved
9080 0x40 Trap IRQ
9081 0x80 Trap FIQ
9082 @end example
9083 @end deffn
9084
9085 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9086 @cindex vector_table
9087
9088 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9089 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9090 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9091 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9092 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9093
9094 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9095
9096 @end deffn
9097
9098 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9099 @cindex ARMv6
9100
9101 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9102 @cindex ARM11
9103
9104 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9105 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9106 which is enabled by default.
9107 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9108 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9109 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9110 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9111 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9112 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9113 @end deffn
9114
9115 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9116 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9117 which is enabled by default.
9118 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9119 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9123 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9124 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9125 they are disabled by default.
9126 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9127 @end deffn
9128
9129 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9130 @cindex vector_catch
9131 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9132 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9133 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9134
9135 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9136 for certain hardware events.
9137 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9138 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9139 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9140 @end deffn
9141
9142 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9143 @cindex ARMv7
9144 @cindex ARMv8
9145
9146 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9147 @cindex Cortex-A
9148
9149 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9150 display information about target caches
9151 @end deffn
9152
9153 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9154 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9155 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9156 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9157 Defaults to 'off'.
9158 @end deffn
9159
9160 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9161 Initialize core debug
9162 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9163 @end deffn
9164
9165 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9166 Display/set the current SMP mode
9167 @end deffn
9168
9169 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9170 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9171 @end deffn
9172
9173 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9174 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9175 @end deffn
9176
9177 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9178 configure l2x cache
9179 @end deffn
9180
9181 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9182 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9183 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9184 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9185 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9186 @end deffn
9187
9188 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9189 @cindex Cortex-R
9190
9191 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9192 Initialize core debug
9193 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9194 @end deffn
9195
9196 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9197 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9198 @end deffn
9199
9200
9201 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9202 @cindex tracing
9203 @cindex SWO
9204 @cindex SWV
9205 @cindex TPIU
9206 @cindex ITM
9207 @cindex ETM
9208
9209 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9210 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9211 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9212
9213 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9214 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9215 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9216 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9217
9218 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9219 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9220 debugger adapter features.
9221
9222 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9223 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9224
9225 Command options:
9226 @itemize @minus
9227 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9228 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9229 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9230 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9231 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9232 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9233 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9234 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9235 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9236 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9237 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9238 coding;
9239 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9240 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9241 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9242 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9243 data is to be output via SWO;
9244 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9245 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9246 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9247 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9248 rate automatically.
9249 @end itemize
9250
9251 Example usage:
9252 @enumerate
9253 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9254 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9255 enough to:
9256 @example
9257 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9258 ...
9259 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9260 ...
9261 @end example
9262 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9263 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9264 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9265 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9266 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9267 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9268 @example
9269 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9270 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9271 @end example
9272 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9273 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9274 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9275 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9276 @example
9277 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9278 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9279 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9280 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9281 @end example
9282 @end enumerate
9283 @end deffn
9284
9285 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9286 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9287 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9288 @end deffn
9289
9290 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9291 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9292 @end deffn
9293
9294 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9295 @cindex Cortex-M
9296
9297 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9298 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9299
9300 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9301 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9302 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9303 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9304 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9305 the step command leaves with the core running.
9306
9307 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9308 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9309 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9310 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9311
9312 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9313 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9314 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9315 does.
9316
9317 Default is @option{auto}.
9318 @end deffn
9319
9320 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9321 @cindex vector_catch
9322 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9323 for certain hardware events.
9324
9325 Parameters request interception of
9326 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9327 @option{none} of them,
9328 or one or more of the following:
9329 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9330 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9331 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9332 @option{irq_err},
9333 @option{state_err},
9334 @option{chk_err}, or
9335 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9336 @option{reset}.
9337 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9338 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9339 are mapped to HardFault.
9340 UsageFault checks for
9341 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9342 must also be explicitly enabled.
9343
9344 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9345 @end deffn
9346
9347 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9348 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9349 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9350
9351 @itemize @minus
9352 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9353 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9354 @end itemize
9355
9356 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9357 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9358 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9359 to manually reset the peripherals.
9360 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9361
9362 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9363 instead.
9364 @end deffn
9365
9366 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9367 @cindex ARMv8-A
9368 @cindex aarch64
9369
9370 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9371 Display information about target caches
9372 @end deffn
9373
9374 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9375 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9376 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9377 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9378 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9379 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9380 @end deffn
9381
9382 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9383 @cindex disassemble
9384 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9385 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9386 @end deffn
9387
9388 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9389 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9390 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9391 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9392 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9393 @end deffn
9394
9395 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9396 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9397 @option{on}.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9401 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9402 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9403 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9404 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9405 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9406 @end deffn
9407
9408 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9409
9410 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9411 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9412
9413 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9414
9415 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9416 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9417 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9418 @end deffn
9419
9420 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9421 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9422 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9423 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9424 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9425 @end deffn
9426
9427 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9428
9429 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9430 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9431 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9435
9436 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9437 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9438 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9439 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9440 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9441 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9442 can be collected.
9443
9444 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9445 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9446 tooling.
9447
9448 @quotation Issues
9449 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9450 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9451 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9452 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9453
9454 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9455 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9456 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9457 software operation on the CPU.
9458 @end quotation
9459
9460 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9461 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9462 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9463 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9464 @end deffn
9465
9466 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9467 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9468 @end deffn
9469
9470 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9471 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9472 control is disabled.
9473 @end deffn
9474
9475 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9476 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9477 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9478 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9479
9480 Supported trace formats:
9481 @itemize
9482 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9483 timing to be determined.
9484 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9485 addresses.
9486 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9487 @end itemize
9488 @end deffn
9489
9490 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9491 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9492 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9493 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9494
9495 Supported conditions:
9496 @itemize
9497 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9498 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9499 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9500 instruction matches start data and mask.
9501 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9502 instruction matches start data and mask.
9503 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9504 data and mask.
9505 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9506 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9507 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9508 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9509 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9510 @end itemize
9511 @end deffn
9512
9513 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9514 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9515 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9516 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9517
9518 Supported conditions:
9519 @itemize
9520 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9521 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9522 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9523 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9524 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9525 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9526 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9527 data and mask.
9528 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9529 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9530 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9531 @end itemize
9532 @end deffn
9533
9534 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9535 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9536
9537 Supported triggers:
9538 @itemize
9539 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9540 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9541 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9542 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9543 collection.
9544 @end itemize
9545 @end deffn
9546
9547 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9548
9549 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9550 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9551 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9552 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9553 @end deffn
9554
9555 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9556 Display trace configuration.
9557 @end deffn
9558
9559 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9560 Display trace collection status.
9561 @end deffn
9562
9563 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9564 Start manual trace collection.
9565 @end deffn
9566
9567 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9568 Stop manual trace collection.
9569 @end deffn
9570
9571 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9572 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9573 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9574 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9575 @option{size} options using DMA.
9576 @end deffn
9577
9578 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9579 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9580 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9581 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9582 @option{size} options using DMA.
9583 @end deffn
9584
9585 @section Intel Architecture
9586
9587 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9588 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9589 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9590 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9591 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9592 @itemize
9593 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9594 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9595 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9596 @end itemize
9597
9598 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9599 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9600 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9601
9602 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9603 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9604 @end deffn
9605
9606 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9607 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9608 @end deffn
9609
9610 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9611 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9612 @end deffn
9613
9614 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9615 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9616 @end deffn
9617
9618 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9619 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9620 @end deffn
9621
9622 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9623 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9624 @end deffn
9625
9626 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9627
9628 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9629 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9630
9631 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9632 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9633 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9634 @end deffn
9635 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9636 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9637
9638 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9639
9640 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9641 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9642 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9643 @end deffn
9644
9645 @subsection Registers commands
9646 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9647 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9648 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9649
9650 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9651
9652 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9653 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9654 and "timer" groups.
9655
9656 @emph{example:}
9657 @example
9658 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9659 @end example
9660
9661
9662 @end deffn
9663 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9664 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9665
9666 @emph{group} can be "system",
9667 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9668 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9669 @end deffn
9670
9671 @section RISC-V Architecture
9672
9673 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9674 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9675 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9676 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9677 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9678 implement version 0.11.
9679
9680 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9681
9682 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9683 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9684 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9685
9686 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9687
9688 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9689 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9690 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9691
9692 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9693 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9694 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9695 CSRs.
9696 @end deffn
9697
9698 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9699 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9700 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9701 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9702 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9703 This command must be executed before `init`.
9704 @end deffn
9705
9706 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9707 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9708 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9709 @end deffn
9710
9711 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9712 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9713 deasserted.
9714 @end deffn
9715
9716 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9717 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9718 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9719 @end deffn
9720
9721 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9722 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
9723 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9724 @end deffn
9725
9726 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
9727 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
9728 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
9729 on physical memory.
9730 @end deffn
9731
9732 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
9733 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
9734 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
9735 performed on physical memory.
9736 @end deffn
9737
9738 @deffn Command {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
9739 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
9740 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
9741 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
9742 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
9743 race condition problem in your code.
9744
9745 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
9746 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
9747 @end deffn
9748
9749 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9750 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9751 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9752 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9753 values.
9754
9755 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9756 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9757 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9758 @end deffn
9759
9760 @deffn Command {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
9761 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
9762 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
9763 @end deffn
9764
9765 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
9766 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9767 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9768 @end deffn
9769
9770 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
9771 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9772 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9773 @end deffn
9774
9775 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
9776 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
9777 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
9778 @end deffn
9779
9780 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9781
9782 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9783 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9784 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9785 @example
9786 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9787 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9788 @end example
9789
9790 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9791 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9792 @end deffn
9793
9794 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9795 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9796 @end deffn
9797
9798 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9799
9800 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9801 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9802
9803 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read} address
9804 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9805 @end deffn
9806
9807 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9808 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9809 @end deffn
9810
9811 @section ARC Architecture
9812 @cindex ARC
9813
9814 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
9815 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
9816 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
9817 at: http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx.
9818 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
9819 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
9820 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
9821 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
9822 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
9823 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
9824 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
9825 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
9826 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
9827 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
9828 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
9829
9830
9831 @subsection General ARC commands
9832
9833 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
9834
9835 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
9836 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
9837 arguments:
9838
9839 @itemize @bullet
9840
9841 @item @code{-name} name
9842 @*Name of a register.
9843
9844 @item @code{-num} number
9845 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
9846
9847 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
9848 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
9849
9850 @end itemize
9851
9852 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
9853
9854 @itemize @bullet
9855
9856 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
9857 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
9858 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
9859 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
9860 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
9861 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
9862
9863 @item @code{-core}
9864 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
9865 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
9866 spaces.
9867
9868 @item @code{-bcr}
9869 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
9870 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
9871 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
9872 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
9873 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
9874
9875 @item @code{-type} type_name
9876 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
9877 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
9878
9879 @item @code{-g}
9880 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
9881 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
9882 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
9883 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
9884 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
9885
9886 @end itemize
9887
9888 @end deffn
9889
9890 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
9891 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
9892 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
9893 @end deffn
9894
9895 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
9896 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
9897 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
9898 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
9899 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
9900 startbit endbit}.
9901 @end deffn
9902
9903 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
9904 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
9905 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
9906 @end deffn
9907
9908 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
9909 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
9910 as an argument for a single command invocation.
9911 @end deffn
9912
9913 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
9914
9915 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
9916 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
9917 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9918 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9919
9920 @end deffn
9921
9922 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
9923 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
9924 registers.
9925 @end deffn
9926
9927 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
9928 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
9929 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
9930 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
9931
9932 @end deffn
9933
9934 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
9935 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
9936 registers.
9937 @end deffn
9938
9939 @section STM8 Architecture
9940 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
9941 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
9942
9943 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
9944 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
9945
9946 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9947 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9948 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9949 @cindex tracing
9950 @cindex libdcc
9951 @cindex DCC
9952 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9953 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9954 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9955 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9956
9957 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9958 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9959 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9960 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9961 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9962 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9963
9964 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9965 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9966 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9967 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9968 The target being debugged may
9969 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9970 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9971 each supported by a command:
9972
9973 @itemize
9974 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9975 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9976 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9977 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9978
9979 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9980 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9981 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9982
9983 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9984 and then displayed at any time.
9985 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9986
9987 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9988 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9989 @end itemize
9990
9991 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9992 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9993 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9994 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9995 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9996 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9997 does the same thing.
9998
9999 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10000 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10001 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10002 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10003 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10004
10005 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10006 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10007 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10008 @end deffn
10009
10010 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10011 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10012 in the order they triggered.
10013 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10014 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10015 history records.
10016 @end deffn
10017
10018 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10019 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10020 they have been triggered.
10021 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10022 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10023 and associates it with that identifier.
10024
10025 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10026 are not related except by this command.
10027 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10028 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10029 @end deffn
10030
10031
10032 @node JTAG Commands
10033 @chapter JTAG Commands
10034 @cindex JTAG Commands
10035 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10036 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10037 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10038 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10039 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10040
10041 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10042 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10043
10044 @itemize @bullet
10045 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10046 devices such as a CPUs.
10047 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10048 standard state machine (in parallel)
10049 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10050 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10051 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10052 while the reading previous ones.
10053 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10054 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10055 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10056 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10057 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10058 registers.
10059 @end itemize
10060
10061 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10062
10063 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10064 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10065 the order of TAP state transitions.
10066 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10067 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10068 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10069 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10070 these commands are not available.
10071
10072 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10073 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10074 that specify the entire register.
10075 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10076 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10077 The return value holds the original value of each
10078 of those fields.
10079
10080 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10081 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10082 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10083 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10084 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10085
10086 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10087 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10088
10089 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10090 in that state.
10091 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10092 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10093 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10094
10095 @quotation Warning
10096 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10097 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10098 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10099 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10100 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10101 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10102 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10103 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10104 @end quotation
10105 @end deffn
10106
10107 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10108 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10109 This may be used for performance tuning.
10110
10111 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10112 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10113 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10114 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10115 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10116 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10117 @end deffn
10118
10119 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10120 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10121 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10122 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10123 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10124 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10125
10126 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10127 in that state.
10128 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10129 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10130 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10131
10132 @quotation Note
10133 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10134 register values, unlike data register values.
10135 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10136 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10137 @end quotation
10138 @end deffn
10139
10140 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10141 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10142 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10143 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10144 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10145 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10146 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10147 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10148 The final state must also be stable.
10149 @end deffn
10150
10151 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10152 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10153 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10154 Instructions often need some time
10155 to execute before they take effect.
10156 @end deffn
10157
10158 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10159 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10160
10161 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10162 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10163 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10164 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10165 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10166 @end deffn
10167
10168 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10169 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10170 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10171 must also be enabled.
10172 Default is enabled.
10173 @end deffn
10174
10175 @section TAP state names
10176 @cindex TAP state names
10177
10178 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10179 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10180 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10181 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10182
10183 @itemize @bullet
10184 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10185 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10186 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10187 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10188 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10189 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10190 through the data register
10191 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10192 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10193 for update or more shifting
10194 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10195 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10196 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10197 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10198 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10199 through the instruction register
10200 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10201 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10202 for update or more shifting
10203 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10204 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10205 @end itemize
10206
10207 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10208 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10209 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10210 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10211
10212 @itemize @bullet
10213 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10214 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10215 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10216 may not be as expected.
10217 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10218 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10219 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10220 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10221 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10222 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10223 @end itemize
10224
10225 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10226 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10227
10228 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10229 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10230 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10231 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10232
10233 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10234 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10235 @cindex SVF
10236
10237 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10238 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10239 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10240 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10241
10242 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10243 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10244 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10245 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10246
10247 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10248 affect their semantics.
10249
10250 Command options:
10251 @itemize @minus
10252 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10253 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10254 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10255 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10256 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10257 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10258 on the real interface;
10259 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10260 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10261 errors.
10262 @end itemize
10263 @end deffn
10264
10265 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10266 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10267 @cindex XSVF
10268
10269 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10270 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10271 Xilinx devices.
10272 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10273 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10274
10275 @quotation Important
10276 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10277 @end quotation
10278
10279 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10280 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10281 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10282 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10283 that TAP.
10284 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10285 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10286 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10287 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10288 @end deffn
10289
10290 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10291 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10292 after building the software.
10293 You may find them useful:
10294
10295 @itemize
10296 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10297 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10298 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10299 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10300 @end itemize
10301
10302 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10303 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10304 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10305 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10306 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10307 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10308 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10309
10310
10311 @node Utility Commands
10312 @chapter Utility Commands
10313 @cindex Utility Commands
10314
10315 @section RAM testing
10316 @cindex RAM testing
10317
10318 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10319 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10320 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10321 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10322 hardware problems.
10323
10324 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10325 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10326 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10327 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10328
10329 Load the memory testing functions with
10330
10331 @example
10332 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10333 @end example
10334
10335 to get access to the following facilities:
10336
10337 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10338 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10339 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10340 @end deffn
10341
10342 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10343 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10344 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10345 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10346 @end deffn
10347
10348 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10349 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10350 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10351 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10352 @end deffn
10353
10354 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10355 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10356 @end deffn
10357
10358 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10359 @cindex Firmware recovery
10360
10361 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10362 devices recovery with JTAG.
10363
10364 For quickstart instructions run:
10365 @example
10366 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10367 @end example
10368
10369 @node TFTP
10370 @chapter TFTP
10371 @cindex TFTP
10372 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10373 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10374
10375 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10376 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10377 server (tftpd). For example,
10378
10379 @example
10380 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10381 @end example
10382
10383 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10384 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10385
10386 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10387 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10388 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10389 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10390
10391 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10392 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10393 @cindex GDB
10394 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10395 to debug remote targets.
10396 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10397
10398 @itemize
10399 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10400 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10401 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10402 as shown in this chapter.
10403 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10404 that also will probably need to be configured.
10405 @end itemize
10406
10407 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10408 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10409 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10410 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10411 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10412 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10413
10414 @section Connecting to GDB
10415 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10416 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10417 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10418 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10419 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10420
10421 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10422
10423 @enumerate
10424 @item
10425 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10426 @example
10427 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10428 @end example
10429 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10430
10431 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10432 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10433 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10434
10435 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10436 remote command above that becomes:
10437 @example
10438 tar ext :3333
10439 @end example
10440
10441 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10442 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10443 available through the command:
10444 @example
10445 target remote localhost:3333
10446 @end example
10447
10448 @item
10449 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10450 @example
10451 target extended-remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10452 @end example
10453 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10454 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10455 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10456 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10457 @end enumerate
10458
10459 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10460 GDB command line.
10461
10462 @section Sample GDB session startup
10463
10464 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10465 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10466 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10467 small ARM program.
10468 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10469 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10470
10471 @example
10472 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10473 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10474 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10475 ...
10476 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10477 ...
10478 (gdb) load
10479 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10480 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10481 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10482 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10483 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10484 (gdb) continue
10485 Continuing.
10486 ...
10487 @end example
10488
10489 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10490 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10491 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10492 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10493
10494 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10495
10496 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10497 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10498 packet size and the device's memory map.
10499 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10500 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10501 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10502
10503 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10504 You may need to set those up by hand.
10505 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10506 something like:
10507
10508 @example
10509 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10510 @end example
10511
10512 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10513
10514 @example
10515 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10516 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10517 @end example
10518
10519 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10520 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10521 do not have such restrictions.
10522
10523 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10524 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10525 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10526 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10527
10528 @section Programming using GDB
10529 @cindex Programming using GDB
10530 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10531
10532 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10533 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10534 @example
10535 gdb_memory_map disable
10536 @end example
10537 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10538 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10539 working area.
10540
10541 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10542 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10543 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10544 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10545
10546 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10547 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10548
10549 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10550 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10551 @example
10552 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10553 @end example
10554
10555 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10556 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10557
10558 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10559 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10560 will be used.
10561
10562 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10563 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10564 @example
10565 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10566 @end example
10567 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10568
10569 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10570 can be used.
10571
10572 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10573 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10574 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10575
10576 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10577 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10578 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10579
10580 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10581 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10582 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10583 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10584 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10585 without any intrusion of the target process.
10586
10587 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10588 Place following command after target configuration:
10589 @example
10590 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10591 @end example
10592
10593 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10594 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10595 @example
10596 gdb_memory_map disable
10597 @end example
10598
10599 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10600 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10601 @example
10602 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10603 @end example
10604
10605 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10606 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10607
10608 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10609 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10610 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10611 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10612
10613 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10614 previously shown variables.
10615
10616 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10617 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10618 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10619 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10620 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10621
10622 @section RTOS Support
10623 @cindex RTOS Support
10624 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10625
10626 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10627 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10628
10629 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10630 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10631 GDB commands.
10632
10633 @* An example setup is below:
10634
10635 @example
10636 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10637 @end example
10638
10639 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10640
10641 Currently supported rtos's include:
10642 @itemize @bullet
10643 @item @option{eCos}
10644 @item @option{ThreadX}
10645 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10646 @item @option{linux}
10647 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10648 @item @option{embKernel}
10649 @item @option{mqx}
10650 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10651 @item @option{nuttx}
10652 @item @option{RIOT}
10653 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10654 @end itemize
10655
10656 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10657 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10658
10659 @table @code
10660 @item eCos symbols
10661 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10662 @item ThreadX symbols
10663 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10664 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10665 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10666 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10667 @tex
10668 \begingroup
10669 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10670 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10671 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10672 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10673 \par
10674 \endgroup
10675 @end tex
10676 @item linux symbols
10677 init_task.
10678 @item ChibiOS symbols
10679 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10680 @item embKernel symbols
10681 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10682 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10683 @item mqx symbols
10684 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10685 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10686 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10687 @item nuttx symbols
10688 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10689 @item RIOT symbols
10690 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads, _tcb_name_offset
10691 @end table
10692
10693 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10694 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10695
10696 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10697 along with the project:
10698
10699 @table @code
10700 @item FreeRTOS
10701 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10702 @item uC/OS-III
10703 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10704 @end table
10705
10706 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10707 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10708 @cindex SMP
10709 @cindex RTOS
10710 @cindex hwthread
10711 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10712 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10713 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10714 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10715 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10716 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10717 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10718 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10719 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10720
10721 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10722 @quotation Note
10723 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10724 @end quotation
10725
10726 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10727 @itemize @bullet
10728 @item j - smp status request
10729 @item J - smp set request
10730 @end itemize
10731
10732 OpenOCD implements :
10733 @itemize @bullet
10734 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10735 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10736 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10737 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10738 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10739 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10740 @end itemize
10741
10742 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10743 @itemize @bullet
10744 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10745 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10746 @example
10747 set $_core 1
10748 #Jc01 packet is sent
10749 print $_core
10750 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10751 @end example
10752
10753 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10754 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10755
10756 @example
10757 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10758 define toggle0
10759 maint packet Jc0
10760 continue
10761 main packet Jc-1
10762 end
10763 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10764 define toggle1
10765 maint packet Jc1
10766 continue
10767 main packet Jc-1
10768 end
10769 @end example
10770 @end itemize
10771
10772 @node Tcl Scripting API
10773 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10774 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10775 @cindex Tcl scripts
10776 @section API rules
10777
10778 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10779 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10780 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10781
10782 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10783 pair list and lists.
10784
10785 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10786 list.
10787
10788 @example
10789 > set foo(me) Duane
10790 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10791 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10792 > set foo(duck) Donald
10793 @end example
10794
10795 If one does this:
10796
10797 @example
10798 > set foo
10799 @end example
10800
10801 The result is:
10802
10803 @example
10804 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10805 @end example
10806
10807 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10808
10809 @verbatim
10810 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10811 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10812 }
10813 @end verbatim
10814
10815 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10816 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10817
10818 @section Internal low-level Commands
10819
10820 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10821 invoke directly.
10822
10823 @itemize @bullet
10824 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10825
10826 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10827 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10828
10829 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10830 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10831
10832 Return information about the flash banks
10833
10834 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10835
10836 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10837 its execution. Example:
10838
10839 @example
10840 > capture "reset init"
10841 @end example
10842
10843 @end itemize
10844
10845 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10846 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10847 called "flash_banks".
10848
10849 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10850
10851 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10852 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10853 holds one of the following values:
10854
10855 @itemize @bullet
10856 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10857 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10858 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10859 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10860 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10861 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10862 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10863 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10864 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10865 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10866 @end itemize
10867
10868 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10869
10870 @quotation Note
10871 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10872 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10873 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10874 is jim, not real tcl).
10875 @end quotation
10876
10877 @section Tcl RPC server
10878 @cindex RPC
10879
10880 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10881 commands and receive the results.
10882
10883 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10884 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10885 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10886 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10887 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10888
10889 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10890 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10891 @command{capture} command.
10892
10893 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10894
10895 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10896 @cindex RPC Notifications
10897
10898 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10899 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10900
10901 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10902 in the following format.
10903
10904 @verbatim
10905 type target_event event [event-name]
10906 type target_state state [state-name]
10907 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10908 @end verbatim
10909
10910 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10911 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10912 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10913 Defaults to off.
10914
10915 @end deffn
10916
10917 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10918 @cindex RPC trace output
10919
10920 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10921 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10922
10923 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10924
10925 @verbatim
10926 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10927 @end verbatim
10928
10929 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10930 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10931 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10932 Defaults to off.
10933
10934 See an example application here:
10935 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10936
10937 @end deffn
10938
10939 @node FAQ
10940 @chapter FAQ
10941 @cindex faq
10942 @enumerate
10943 @anchor{faqrtck}
10944 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10945 @cindex RTCK
10946 @cindex adaptive clocking
10947 @*
10948
10949 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10950 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10951 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10952 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10953
10954 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10955 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10956 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10957 @enumerate
10958 @item
10959 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10960 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10961 @item
10962 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10963 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10964 @end enumerate
10965
10966 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10967 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10968 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10969 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10970 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10971 power).
10972
10973 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10974 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10975 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10976 ARM926 scenario).
10977 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10978 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10979 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10980
10981 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10982 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10983 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10984 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10985
10986 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10987
10988 In order to make use of this,
10989 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10990 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10991
10992 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10993 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10994 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10995 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10996 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10997
10998 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10999 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11000 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11001 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11002
11003 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11004 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11005 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11006 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11007 with a CPLD.
11008 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11009 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11010 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11011 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11012 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11013 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11014
11015 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11016
11017 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11018
11019 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11020 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11021 depending on the chips on your board.
11022 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11023 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11024 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11025
11026 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11027 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11028 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11029
11030 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11031 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11032 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11033 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11034
11035 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11036 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11037 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11038 this way.
11039
11040 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11041 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11042 clock rate.
11043 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11044 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11045 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11046
11047 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11048
11049 @example
11050 # Example: 1.234MHz
11051 adapter speed 1234
11052 @end example
11053
11054
11055 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11056
11057 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11058 around Windows filenames.
11059
11060 @example
11061 > echo \a
11062
11063 > echo @{\a@}
11064 \a
11065 > echo "\a"
11066
11067 >
11068 @end example
11069
11070
11071 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11072
11073 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11074 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11075 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11076
11077 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11078 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11079 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11080
11081 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11082 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11083 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11084
11085 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11086
11087 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11088 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11089 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11090 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11091
11092 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11093 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11094 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11095
11096 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11097 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11098
11099 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11100 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11101 memory read caused data abort".
11102
11103 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11104 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11105 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11106 be done, feel free to add this here.
11107
11108 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11109 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11110 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11111 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11112 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11113 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11114 gracefully stops.
11115
11116 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11117 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11118 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11119
11120 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11121 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11122 bytes. Painful...
11123
11124
11125 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11126 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11127
11128 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11129 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11130 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11131 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11132 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11133 reset, everything else should work fine.
11134
11135 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11136 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11137 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11138 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11139
11140 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11141 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11142 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11143 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11144
11145 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11146
11147 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11148 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11149 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11150
11151 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11152 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11153
11154 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11155 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11156 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11157 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11158 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11159 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11160 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11161 clock frequency?
11162
11163 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11164 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11165 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11166 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11167 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11168
11169 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11170
11171 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11172 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11173 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11174 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11175 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11176 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11177 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11178
11179 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11180
11181 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11182 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11183 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11184 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11185
11186 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11187 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11188 particular order?
11189
11190 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11191 the same order used by the hardware.
11192
11193 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11194 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11195 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11196 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11197 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11198 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11199
11200 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11201 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11202 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11203 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11204
11205 @itemize @bullet
11206 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11207 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11208 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11209 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11210 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11211 @end itemize
11212
11213 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11214
11215 @itemize @bullet
11216 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11217 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11218 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11219 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11220 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11221 @end itemize
11222
11223
11224 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11225 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11226 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11227
11228 TODO.
11229
11230 @end enumerate
11231
11232 @node Tcl Crash Course
11233 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11234 @cindex Tcl
11235
11236 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11237 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11238 how the Tcl scripts work.
11239
11240 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11241 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11242 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11243 OpenOCD.
11244
11245 @section Tcl Rule #1
11246 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11247 @enumerate
11248 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11249 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11250 @end enumerate
11251
11252 The Tcl equal is this:
11253
11254 @enumerate
11255 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11256 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11257 @end enumerate
11258
11259 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11260 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11261
11262 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11263 There is a second pair of rules.
11264 @enumerate
11265 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11266 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11267 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11268 in Tcl.
11269 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11270 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11271 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11272 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11273 @end enumerate
11274
11275 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11276 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11277 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11278 Everything is a string}
11279
11280 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11281 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11282 difference is subtle.
11283 @enumerate
11284 @item Parse Time
11285 @item Evaluation Time
11286 @end enumerate
11287
11288 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11289 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11290 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11291
11292 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11293 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11294 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11295 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11296
11297 @itemize @bullet
11298 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11299 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11300 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11301 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11302 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11303 @example
11304 # bash example
11305 X=`date`
11306 echo "The Date is: $X"
11307 # Tcl example
11308 set X [date]
11309 puts "The Date is: $X"
11310 @end example
11311 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11312 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11313 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11314 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11315 is a string}
11316 @example
11317 set x "Dinner"
11318 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11319 @end example
11320 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11321 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11322 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11323 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11324 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11325 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11326 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11327 @end itemize
11328
11329 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11330
11331 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11332
11333 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11334
11335 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11336 the normal way.
11337
11338 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11339 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11340 line is immediately executed.
11341
11342 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11343 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11344
11345 @subsection Command Execution
11346
11347 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11348 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11349 control flow operators.
11350
11351 Commands are executed like this:
11352
11353 @enumerate
11354 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11355 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11356 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11357 @end enumerate
11358
11359 It sort of works like this:
11360 @example
11361 for(;;)@{
11362 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11363
11364 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11365
11366 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11367 @}
11368 @end example
11369
11370 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11371 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11372 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11373 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11374 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11375 ``LookupCommand()''
11376
11377 @subsection The FOR command
11378
11379 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11380 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11381 command just like any other command.
11382
11383 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11384 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11385 are:
11386
11387 @enumerate 0
11388 @item The ascii text 'for'
11389 @item The start text
11390 @item The test expression
11391 @item The next text
11392 @item The body text
11393 @end enumerate
11394
11395 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11396 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11397 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11398 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11399
11400 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11401 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11402
11403 @example
11404 int
11405 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11406 int *argc,
11407 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11408 @end example
11409
11410 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11411 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11412 still operates in the same basic way.
11413
11414 @subsection FOR command implementation
11415
11416 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11417 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11418
11419 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11420
11421 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11422
11423 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11424 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11425 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11426
11427 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11428 expression and returns a value.
11429
11430 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11431 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11432 @example
11433 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11434
11435 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11436
11437 int
11438 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11439 int argc,
11440 char **argv )
11441 @{
11442 if( argc != 5 )@{
11443 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11444 return ERROR;
11445 @}
11446
11447 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11448
11449 // Execute the start statement.
11450 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11451
11452 // Top of loop test
11453 for(;;)@{
11454 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11455 if( i == 0 )
11456 break;
11457
11458 // Execute the body
11459 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11460
11461 // Execute the LOOP part
11462 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11463 @}
11464
11465 // Return no error
11466 SetResult( interp, "" );
11467 return SUCCESS;
11468 @}
11469 @end example
11470
11471 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11472 in the same basic way.
11473
11474 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11475
11476 @subsection source and find commands
11477 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11478 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11479 @*Remember the parsing rules
11480 @enumerate
11481 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11482 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11483 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11484 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11485 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11486 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11487 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11488 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11489 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11490 @end enumerate
11491 @subsection format command
11492 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11493 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11494 @b{sprintf()}.
11495 @b{Example}
11496 @example
11497 set x 6
11498 set y 7
11499 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11500 @end example
11501 @enumerate
11502 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11503 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11504 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11505 @* Refer to Rule #1
11506 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11507 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11508 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11509 @end enumerate
11510 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11511 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11512 @example
11513 #1 Good
11514 proc someproc @{@} @{
11515 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11516 @}
11517 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11518 #2 Good - no variables
11519 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11520 #3 Good Curly Braces
11521 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11522 puts "Time: [date]"
11523 @}
11524 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11525 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11526 @end example
11527 @enumerate
11528 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11529 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11530 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11531 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11532 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11533 command.
11534 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11535 @*There are 4 examples:
11536 @enumerate
11537 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11538 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11539 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11540 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11541 @end enumerate
11542
11543 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11544 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11545 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11546
11547 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11548 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11549 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11550 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11551 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11552 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11553 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11554 @end enumerate
11555 @subsection Global Variables
11556 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11557 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11558 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11559 @example
11560 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11561 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11562 global x #Global variable X
11563 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11564 @}
11565 @end example
11566 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11567 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11568 @example
11569 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11570 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11571 # Create var name
11572 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11573 # Make it a global
11574 global $vn
11575 # Set it.
11576 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11577 @}
11578 @end example
11579 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11580 @example
11581 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11582 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11583 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11584 @}
11585 @end example
11586
11587 @include fdl.texi
11588
11589 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11590 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11591 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11592 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11593 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11594 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11595
11596 @printindex cp
11597
11598 @node Command and Driver Index
11599 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11600 @printindex fn
11601
11602 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)